370 KiB
370 KiB
1 | Book | Chapter | Verse | ID | SupportReference | OrigQuote | Occurrence | GLQuote | OccurrenceNote |
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
2 | MRK | front | intro | r2f2 | 0 | # Introduction to the Gospel of Mark<br><br>## Part 1: General Introduction<br><br>### Outline of the Book of Mark<br><br>1. Introduction (1:1-13)<br>1. The ministry of Jesus in Galilee<br> * Early ministry (1:14-3:6)<br> * Jesus becomes more popular among the people (3:7-5:43)<br> * Moving away from Galilee and then returning (6:1-8:26)<br>1. Progress toward Jerusalem, repeated times when Jesus predicts his own death; the disciples misunderstand, and Jesus teaches them how difficult it will be to follow him (8:27-10:52)<br>1. Last days of ministry and preparation for final conflict in Jerusalem (11:1-13:37)<br>1. The death of Christ and the empty tomb (14:1-16:8)<br><br>### What is the Book of Mark about?<br><br>The Gospel of Mark is one of four books in the New Testament that describe some of the life of Jesus Christ. The authors of the gospels wrote about different aspects of who Jesus was and what he did. Mark wrote much about how Jesus suffered and died on the cross. He did this to encourage his readers who were being persecuted. Mark also explained Jewish customs and some Aramaic words. This may indicate that Mark expected most of his first readers to be Gentiles.<br><br>### How should the title of this book be translated?<br><br>Translators may choose to call this book by its traditional title, “The Gospel of Mark,” or “The Gospel according to Mark.” They may also choose a title that may be clearer, such as, “The Good News about Jesus that Mark wrote.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])<br><br>### Who wrote the Book of Mark?<br><br>The book does not give the name of the author. However, since early Christian times, most Christians have thought that the author was Mark. Mark was also known as John Mark. He was a close friend of Peter. Mark may not have witnessed what Jesus said and did. But many scholars think that Mark wrote in his gospel what Peter told him about Jesus.<br><br>## Part 2: Important Religious and Cultural Concepts<br><br>### What were Jesus’ teaching methods?<br><br>The people regarded Jesus as a rabbi. A rabbi is a teacher of God’s law. Jesus taught in similar ways as other religious teachers in Israel. He had students who followed him wherever he went. These students were called disciples. He often told parables. Parables are stories that teach moral lessons. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/lawofmoses]] and [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/disciple]] and [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/parable]])<br><br>## Part 3: Important Translation Issues<br><br>### What are the Synoptic Gospels?<br><br>The Gospels of Matthew, Mark, and Luke are called the Synoptic Gospels because they have many similar passages. The word “synoptic” means to “see together.”<br><br>The texts are considered “parallel” when they are the same or almost the same among two or three gospels. When translating parallel passages, translators should use the same wording and make them as similar as possible.<br><br>### Why does Jesus refer to himself as the “Son of Man”?<br><br>In the gospels, Jesus calls himself the “Son of Man.” It is a reference to Daniel 7:13-14. In this passage there is a person described as a “son of man.” That means the person was someone who looked like a human being. God gave authority to the son of man to rule over the nations forever. And all the people will worship him forever.<br><br>Jews of Jesus’ time did not use “Son of Man” as a title for anyone. Therefore, Jesus used it for himself to help them understand who he truly was. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/sonofman]])<br><br>Translating the title “Son of Man” can be difficult in many languages. Readers may misunderstand a literal translation. Translators can consider alternatives, such as “The Human One.” It may also be helpful to include a footnote to explain the title.<br><br>### Why does Mark frequently use terms indicating short periods of time?<br><br>The Gospel of Mark uses the word “immediately” forty-two times. Mark does this to make the events more exciting and vivid. It moves the reader quickly from one event to the next.<br><br>### What are the major issues in the text of the Book of Mark?<br><br>The following verses are found in older versions of the Bible but are not included in most modern versions. Translators are advised not to include these verses. However, if in the translators’ region, there are older versions of the Bible that include one or more of these verses, the translators can include them. If they are included, they should be put inside square brackets ([]) to indicate that they were probably not original to Mark’s Gospel.<br>* “If any man has ears to hear, let him hear.” (7:16)<br>* “where their worm never dies and the fire is never quenched” (9:44)<br>* “where their worm never dies and the fire is never quenched” (9:46)<br>* “And the scripture was fulfilled that says, ‘He was counted with the lawless ones’” (15:28)<br><br>The following passage in not found in the earliest manuscripts. Most Bibles include this passage, but modern Bibles put it in brackets ([]) or indicate in some way that this passage may not have been original to Mark’s Gospel. Translators are advised to do something similar as the modern versions of the Bible.<br>* “Early on the first day of the week, after he arose, he appeared first to Mary Magdalene, from whom he had cast out seven demons. She went and told those who were with him, while they were mourning and weeping. They heard that he was alive and that he had been seen by her, but they did not believe. After these things he appeared in a different form to two of them, as they were walking out into the country. They went and told the rest of the disciples, but they did not believe them. Jesus later appeared to the eleven as they were reclining at the table, and he rebuked them for their unbelief and hardness of heart, because they did not believe those who saw him after he rose from the dead. He said to them, ‘Go into all the world, and preach the gospel to the entire creation. He who believes and is baptized will be saved, and he who does not believe will be condemned. These signs will go with those who believe: In my name they will cast out demons. They will speak in new languages. They will pick up snakes with their hands, and if they drink anything deadly, it will not hurt them. They will lay hands on the sick, and they will get well.’ After the Lord had spoken to them, he was taken up into heaven and sat down at the right hand of God. The disciples left and preached everywhere, while the Lord worked with them and confirmed the word by the signs that went with them.” (16:9-20)<br><br>(See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-textvariants]]) | |||
3 | MRK | 1 | intro | c6ep | 0 | # Mark 01 General Notes<br><br>## Structure and formatting<br><br>Some translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 1:2-3, which are words from the Old Testament.<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### “You can make me clean”<br><br>Leprosy was a disease of the skin that made a person unclean and unable to properly worship God. Jesus is capable of making people physically “clean” or healthy as well as spiritually “clean” or right with God. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/clean]])<br><br>### “The kingdom of God is near”<br><br>Scholars debate whether the “kingdom of God” was present at this time or is something that is still coming. English translations frequently use the phrase “at hand,” but this can create difficulty for translators. Other versions use the phase “is coming” and “has come near.” | |||
4 | MRK | 1 | 1 | s8qp | 0 | General Information: | The book of Mark begins with the prophet Isaiah’s foretelling of the coming of John the Baptist, who baptizes Jesus. The author is Mark, also called John Mark, who is the son of one of the several women named Mary mentioned in the four Gospels. He is also the nephew of Barnabas. | ||
5 | MRK | 1 | 1 | i3bc | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | Υἱοῦ Θεοῦ | 1 | Son of God | This is an important title for Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
6 | MRK | 1 | 2 | gu7i | figs-idiom | πρὸ προσώπου σου | 1 | before your face | This is an idiom that means “ahead of you.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
7 | MRK | 1 | 2 | s28q | figs-you | προσώπου σου…τὴν ὁδόν σου | 1 | your face … your way | Here the words **your** refer to Jesus and are singular. When you translate these, use the pronoun “your” because this is a quote from a prophet, and he did not use Jesus’ name. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-you]]) |
8 | MRK | 1 | 2 | wry5 | ὃς | 1 | who | This refers to the messenger. | |
9 | MRK | 1 | 2 | kl12 | figs-metaphor | κατασκευάσει τὴν ὁδόν σου | 1 | will prepare your way | Doing this represents preparing the people for the Lord’s arrival. Alternate translation: “will prepare the people for your arrival” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
10 | MRK | 1 | 3 | lkm3 | φωνὴ βοῶντος ἐν τῇ ἐρήμῳ | 1 | The voice of one crying out in the wilderness | This can be expressed as a sentence. Alternate translation: “The voice of one crying out in the wilderness is heard” or “They hear the sound of someone calling out in the wilderness” | |
11 | MRK | 1 | 3 | v3n3 | figs-parallelism | ἑτοιμάσατε τὴν ὁδὸν Κυρίου, εὐθείας ποιεῖτε τὰς τρίβους αὐτοῦ | 1 | Make ready the way of the Lord; make his paths straight | These two phrases mean the same thing. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]]) |
12 | MRK | 1 | 3 | peh5 | figs-metaphor | ἑτοιμάσατε τὴν ὁδὸν Κυρίου | 1 | Make ready the way of the Lord | “Get the road ready for the Lord.” Doing this represents being prepared to hear the Lord’s message when he comes. Alternate translation: “Prepare to hear the Lord’s message when he comes” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
13 | MRK | 1 | 3 | xlxd | figs-explicit | ἑτοιμάσατε τὴν ὁδὸν Κυρίου | 1 | Make ready the way of the Lord | People prepare for the Lord by repenting of their sins. Alternate translation: “Repent and be ready for the Lord to come” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
14 | MRK | 1 | 4 | j798 | 0 | General Information: | In these verses the words **he**, **him**, and **his** refer to John. | ||
15 | MRK | 1 | 4 | yg66 | ἐγένετο Ἰωάννης | 1 | John came | Be sure your reader understands that John was the messenger spoken of by the prophet Isaiah in the previous verse. | |
16 | MRK | 1 | 5 | u9yg | figs-metaphor | πᾶσα ἡ Ἰουδαία χώρα καὶ οἱ Ἱεροσολυμεῖται πάντες | 1 | the whole region of Judea and all the people of Jerusalem | The word **region** are a metaphor for the people who live in the country. Alternate translation: “the people from Judea and Jerusalem” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
17 | MRK | 1 | 5 | cf75 | figs-hyperbole | πᾶσα ἡ Ἰουδαία χώρα καὶ οἱ Ἱεροσολυμεῖται πάντες | 1 | the whole region of Judea and all the people of Jerusalem | Here, **the whole region** and **all the people** are generalizations that refers to a great number of people, not to every single person. Alternate translation: “many people from Judea and Jerusalem” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
18 | MRK | 1 | 5 | h8h7 | figs-activepassive | ἐβαπτίζοντο ὑπ’ αὐτοῦ ἐν τῷ Ἰορδάνῃ ποταμῷ, ἐξομολογούμενοι τὰς ἁμαρτίας αὐτῶν | 1 | were baptized by him in the Jordan River, confessing their sins | They did these things at the same time. The people were baptized because they repented of their sins. Alternate translation: “when they repented of their sins, John baptized them in the Jordan River” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
19 | MRK | 1 | 7 | l7jd | ἐκήρυσσεν | 1 | he was proclaiming | “John was proclaiming” | |
20 | MRK | 1 | 7 | g8fw | figs-metaphor | οὗ οὐκ εἰμὶ ἱκανὸς, κύψας λῦσαι τὸν ἱμάντα τῶν ὑποδημάτων αὐτοῦ | 1 | of whom the strap of his sandals I am not worthy to stoop down to untie | John is comparing himself to a servant to show how great Jesus is. Alternate translation: “and I am not even worthy to do the lowly task of removing his shoes” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
21 | MRK | 1 | 7 | q5m4 | τὸν ἱμάντα τῶν ὑποδημάτων αὐτοῦ | 1 | the strap of his sandals | At the time Jesus was on earth, people often wore sandals that were made of leather and tied to their feet with leather straps. | |
22 | MRK | 1 | 7 | iz8v | κύψας | 1 | to stoop down | “to bend down” | |
23 | MRK | 1 | 8 | e4qi | figs-metaphor | αὐτὸς δὲ βαπτίσει ὑμᾶς ἐν Πνεύματι Ἁγίῳ | 1 | but he will baptize you with the Holy Spirit | This metaphor compares John’s baptism with water to the future baptism with the **Holy Spirit**. This means John’s baptism only symbolically cleanses people of their sins. The baptism by the Holy Spirit will truly cleanse people of their sins. If possible, use the same word for **baptize** here as you used for John’s baptism to keep the comparison between the two. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
24 | MRK | 1 | 9 | u65k | writing-newevent | ἐγένετο ἐν ἐκείναις ταῖς ἡμέραις | 1 | it happened that in those days | This marks the beginning of a new event in the story line. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-newevent]]) |
25 | MRK | 1 | 9 | gi39 | figs-activepassive | ἐβαπτίσθη…ὑπὸ Ἰωάννου | 1 | he was baptized by John | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “John baptized him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
26 | MRK | 1 | 10 | m5f6 | figs-simile | τὸ Πνεῦμα ὡς περιστερὰν καταβαῖνον ἐπ’ αὐτόν | 1 | the Spirit coming down on him like a dove | This could mean: (1) this is a simile, and **the Spirit** descended upon Jesus as a bird descends from the sky toward the ground or (2) **the Spirit** literally looked **like a dove** as he descended upon Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]]) |
27 | MRK | 1 | 11 | e6ke | figs-metonymy | φωνὴ ἐγένετο ἐκ τῶν οὐρανῶν | 1 | a voice came out of the heavens | The **voice** represents God speaking. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
28 | MRK | 1 | 11 | ky16 | figs-euphemism | φωνὴ ἐγένετο ἐκ τῶν οὐρανῶν | 1 | a voice came out of the heavens | Sometimes people avoid referring directly to God because they respect him. Alternate translation: “God spoke from the heavens” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]]) |
29 | MRK | 1 | 11 | s6f4 | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | ὁ Υἱός μου ὁ ἀγαπητός | 1 | my beloved Son | This is an important title for Jesus. The Father calls Jesus his **beloved Son** because of his eternal love for him. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
30 | MRK | 1 | 12 | yv6v | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After Jesus’ baptism, he is in the wilderness for 40 days and then goes to Galilee to teach and call his disciples. | ||
31 | MRK | 1 | 12 | gp1e | αὐτὸν ἐκβάλλει | 1 | compelled him to go out | “forced Jesus to go out” | |
32 | MRK | 1 | 13 | w3ct | ἦν ἐν τῇ ἐρήμῳ | 1 | he was in the wilderness | “he stayed in the wilderness” | |
33 | MRK | 1 | 13 | k45w | translate-numbers | τεσσεράκοντα ἡμέρας | 1 | 40 days | “forty days” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
34 | MRK | 1 | 13 | siu3 | ἦν μετὰ | 1 | he was with | “he was among” | |
35 | MRK | 1 | 14 | q12s | figs-activepassive | μετὰ…τὸ παραδοθῆναι τὸν Ἰωάννην | 1 | after John was arrested | “after John was placed in prison.” This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “after they arrested John” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
36 | MRK | 1 | 14 | ns6b | κηρύσσων τὸ εὐαγγέλιον | 1 | proclaiming the gospel | “telling many people about the good news” | |
37 | MRK | 1 | 15 | i9a9 | πεπλήρωται ὁ καιρὸς | 1 | The time has been fulfilled | “It is now time” | |
38 | MRK | 1 | 15 | bs8j | ἤγγικεν ἡ Βασιλεία τοῦ Θεοῦ | 1 | the kingdom of God has come near | “it is almost time for God to begin to rule over his people” | |
39 | MRK | 1 | 16 | wl35 | εἶδεν Σίμωνα καὶ Ἀνδρέαν | 1 | he saw Simon and Andrew | “Jesus saw Simon and Andrew” | |
40 | MRK | 1 | 16 | z3j9 | figs-explicit | ἀμφιβάλλοντας ἐν τῇ θαλάσσῃ | 1 | casting a net into the sea | The full meaning of this statement can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “throwing a net into the water to catch fish” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
41 | MRK | 1 | 17 | zui3 | δεῦτε ὀπίσω μου | 1 | Come after me | “Follow me” or “Come with me” | |
42 | MRK | 1 | 17 | mlc6 | figs-metaphor | ποιήσω ὑμᾶς γενέσθαι ἁλιεῖς ἀνθρώπων | 1 | I will make you to become fishers of men | This metaphor means Simon and Andrew will teach people God’s true message, so others will also follow Jesus. Alternate translation: “I will teach you to gather men to me like you gather fish” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
43 | MRK | 1 | 19 | g41w | figs-explicit | ἐν τῷ πλοίῳ | 1 | in the boat | It can be assumed that this **boat** belongs to James and John. Alternate translation: “in their boat” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
44 | MRK | 1 | 19 | xl2m | ἐν τῷ πλοίῳ καταρτίζοντας τὰ δίκτυα | 1 | were in the boat mending the nets | “were in the boat repairing the nets” | |
45 | MRK | 1 | 20 | zjz5 | figs-explicit | ἐκάλεσεν αὐτούς | 1 | having called them | It may be helpful to state clearly why Jesus called to James and John. Alternate translation: “having called them to come with him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
46 | MRK | 1 | 20 | jd8i | τῶν μισθωτῶν | 1 | the hired servants | “the servants who worked for them” | |
47 | MRK | 1 | 20 | b2ci | ἀπῆλθον ὀπίσω αὐτοῦ | 1 | they went after him | James and John went with Jesus. | |
48 | MRK | 1 | 21 | ee4j | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus teaches in the synagogue of the town of Capernaum on the Sabbath. By sending a demon out of a man he amazes the people in all the nearby area around Galilee. | ||
49 | MRK | 1 | 21 | d4mr | εἰσπορεύονται εἰς Καφαρναούμ | 1 | came into Capernaum | “arriving at Capernaum” | |
50 | MRK | 1 | 22 | bsc9 | figs-ellipsis | ἦν γὰρ διδάσκων αὐτοὺς ὡς ἐξουσίαν ἔχων, καὶ οὐχ ὡς οἱ γραμματεῖς | 1 | for he was teaching them as having authority and not as the scribes | The idea of “teach” can be stated clearly when talking about someone **having authority** and **the scribes**. Alternate translation: “for he was teaching them as someone who has authority teaches and not as the scribes teach” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
51 | MRK | 1 | 24 | ra8g | figs-rquestion | τί ἡμῖν καὶ σοί, Ἰησοῦ Ναζαρηνέ? | 1 | What to us and to you, Jesus of Nazareth? | The demons ask this rhetorical question meaning there is no reason for Jesus to interfere with them and that they desire him to leave them. Alternate translation: “Jesus of Nazareth, leave us alone! There is no reason for you to interfere with us.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
52 | MRK | 1 | 24 | m8gz | figs-rquestion | ἦλθες ἀπολέσαι ἡμᾶς | 1 | Have you come to destroy us? | The demons ask this rhetorical question to urge Jesus not to harm them. Alternate translation: “Do not destroy us!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
53 | MRK | 1 | 26 | ar6h | σπαράξαν αὐτὸν | 1 | having thrown him down | Here the word **him** refers to the demon-possessed man. | |
54 | MRK | 1 | 26 | u7rn | φωνῆσαν φωνῇ μεγάλῃ | 1 | having cried out with a loud voice | The demon is the one who is crying out, not the man. | |
55 | MRK | 1 | 27 | lqm1 | figs-rquestion | τί ἐστιν τοῦτο? διδαχὴ καινή κατ’ ἐξουσίαν! καὶ τοῖς πνεύμασι τοῖς ἀκαθάρτοις ἐπιτάσσει, καὶ ὑπακούουσιν αὐτῷ! | 1 | “What is this? A new teaching according to authority! He even commands the unclean spirits and they obey him!” | The people used the two questions to show how amazed they were. The questions can be expressed as exclamations. Alternate translation: “they said to each other, ‘This is amazing! He gives a new teaching, and he speaks with authority! And when he tells the demons what to do, they obey him!’” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
56 | MRK | 1 | 27 | nfv2 | ἐπιτάσσει | 1 | He commands | **He** refers to Jesus. | |
57 | MRK | 1 | 29 | ybs7 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After healing the demon-possessed man, Jesus healed Simon’s mother-in-law and many other people. | ||
58 | MRK | 1 | 30 | ng3t | writing-participants | ἡ δὲ πενθερὰ Σίμωνος κατέκειτο πυρέσσουσα | 1 | Now the mother-in-law of Simon was lying down, being sick with a fever | The word **Now** introduces Simon’s mother-in-law to the story. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-participants]]) |
59 | MRK | 1 | 30 | bvvl | writing-background | ἡ…πενθερὰ Σίμωνος κατέκειτο πυρέσσουσα | 1 | the mother-in-law of Simon was lying down, being sick with a fever | This gives background information about Peter's mother-in-law. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) |
60 | MRK | 1 | 31 | qtw2 | ἤγειρεν αὐτὴν | 1 | he raised her up | “he caused her to stand” or “he made her able to get out of bed” | |
61 | MRK | 1 | 31 | sff6 | figs-explicit | ἀφῆκεν αὐτὴν ὁ πυρετός | 1 | the fever left her | You may want to make explicit who healed her. Alternate translation: “Jesus healed her of the fever” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
62 | MRK | 1 | 31 | i5br | figs-explicit | διηκόνει αὐτοῖς | 1 | she started serving them | You may want to make explicit that she served food. Alternate translation: “she provided them with food and drinks” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
63 | MRK | 1 | 32 | b8sl | 0 | General Information: | Here the words **him** and **he** refer to Jesus. | ||
64 | MRK | 1 | 32 | d1i7 | figs-hyperbole | πάντας τοὺς κακῶς ἔχοντας καὶ τοὺς δαιμονιζομένους | 1 | all those having sickness and those possessed by demons | The word **all** is an exaggeration to emphasize the great number of people who came. Alternate translation: “many who were sick or possessed by demons” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
65 | MRK | 1 | 33 | grp2 | figs-metonymy | ἦν ὅλη ἡ πόλις ἐπισυνηγμένη πρὸς τὴν θύραν | 1 | the whole city was gathered together at the door | The word **city** is a metonym for the people who lived in the city. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
66 | MRK | 1 | 33 | xe3p | figs-hyperbole | ἦν ὅλη ἡ πόλις ἐπισυνηγμένη πρὸς τὴν θύραν | 1 | the whole city was gathered together at the door | Here the word **whole** is probably a generalization to emphasize that most people from the city gathered. Alternate translation: “Many people from that city gathered outside the door” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
67 | MRK | 1 | 35 | zi68 | 0 | General Information: | Here the words **he** and **him** refer to Jesus. | ||
68 | MRK | 1 | 35 | z4kt | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus takes time to pray in the midst of his time of healing people. He then goes to towns throughout Galilee to preach, heal, and cast out demons. | ||
69 | MRK | 1 | 35 | rbb9 | ἔρημον τόπον | 1 | a solitary place | “a place where he could be alone” | |
70 | MRK | 1 | 36 | eia3 | Σίμων καὶ οἱ μετ’ αὐτοῦ | 1 | Simon and those who were with him | Here, **him** refers to Simon. Also, those with him include Andrew, James, John, and possibly other people. | |
71 | MRK | 1 | 37 | vgc7 | figs-hyperbole | πάντες ζητοῦσίν σε | 1 | Everyone is seeking you | The word **Everyone** is an exaggeration to emphasize the very many people who were looking for Jesus. Alternate translation: “Many people are looking for you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
72 | MRK | 1 | 38 | ve8a | 0 | General Information: | Here the words **he** and **I** refer to Jesus. | ||
73 | MRK | 1 | 38 | plm9 | ἄγωμεν ἀλλαχοῦ | 1 | We may go elsewhere | “We need to go to some other place.” Here Jesus uses the word **We** to refer to himself, along with Simon, Andrew, James, and John. | |
74 | MRK | 1 | 39 | zs4i | figs-hyperbole | ἦλθεν…εἰς ὅλην τὴν Γαλιλαίαν | 1 | He went in all of Galilee | The words **in all** are an exaggeration used to emphasize that Jesus went to many locations during his ministry. Alternate translation: “He went to many places in Galilee” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
75 | MRK | 1 | 40 | i2af | ἔρχεται πρὸς αὐτὸν λεπρὸς, παρακαλῶν αὐτὸν καὶ γονυπετῶν λέγων αὐτῷ | 1 | a leper was coming to him, begging him and kneeling down, was saying to him | “a leper came to Jesus. He knelt down and was begging Jesus and said” | |
76 | MRK | 1 | 40 | m4j7 | figs-ellipsis | ἐὰν θέλῃς, δύνασαί με καθαρίσαι | 1 | If you may be willing, you are able to make me clean | In the first phrase, the words “to make me clean” are understood because they appear in the second phrase. Alternate translation: “If you are willing to make me clean, then you can make me clean” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
77 | MRK | 1 | 40 | u9ew | θέλῃς | 1 | you may be willing | “you want” or “you desire” | |
78 | MRK | 1 | 40 | e5am | figs-metaphor | δύνασαί με καθαρίσαι | 1 | you are able to make me clean | In biblical times, a person who had any of certain skin diseases was considered unclean until his skin had healed enough that he was no longer contagious. Alternate translation: “you can heal me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
79 | MRK | 1 | 41 | l9jg | figs-idiom | σπλαγχνισθεὶς | 1 | having been moved with compassion | Here the word **moved** is an idiom meaning to feel emotion about another’s need. Alternate translation: “having compassion for him, Jesus” or “Jesus felt compassion for the man, so” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
80 | MRK | 1 | 41 | qjz4 | figs-ellipsis | θέλω | 1 | I am willing | It may be helpful to state what Jesus is willing to do. Alternate translation: “I am willing to make you clean” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
81 | MRK | 1 | 43 | iw7t | 0 | General Information: | The word **him** used here refers to the leper whom Jesus healed. | ||
82 | MRK | 1 | 44 | a7hs | ὅρα μηδενὶ, μηδὲν εἴπῃς | 1 | See that you may say nothing to anyone | “Be sure to not say anything to anyone” | |
83 | MRK | 1 | 44 | xhu8 | figs-explicit | σεαυτὸν δεῖξον τῷ ἱερεῖ | 1 | show yourself to the priest | Jesus told the man to **show** himself **to the priest** so that the priest could look at his skin to see if his leprosy was really gone. The law of Moses required people to present themselves to the priest if they had been unclean but were no longer unclean. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
84 | MRK | 1 | 44 | w6b2 | figs-synecdoche | σεαυτὸν δεῖξον | 1 | show yourself | The word **yourself** here represents the skin of the leper. Alternate translation: “show your skin” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
85 | MRK | 1 | 44 | ish7 | μαρτύριον αὐτοῖς | 1 | a testimony to them | It is best to use the pronoun **them**, if possible, in your language. This could mean: (1) “a testimony to the priests” or (2) “a testimony to the people.” | |
86 | MRK | 1 | 45 | m63p | ὁ δὲ ἐξελθὼν | 1 | But having gone out, he | The word **he** refers to the man Jesus healed. | |
87 | MRK | 1 | 45 | i91a | figs-metaphor | ἤρξατο κηρύσσειν πολλὰ καὶ διαφημίζειν τὸν λόγον | 1 | began to proclaim often and to spread the word widely | Here, **spread the word widely** is a metaphor for telling people in many places about what had happened. Alternate translation: “began to tell people in many places about what Jesus had done” (See: and [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
88 | MRK | 1 | 45 | bn6r | ὥστε | 1 | so that | “so much that” | |
89 | MRK | 1 | 45 | l9es | figs-explicit | ὥστε μηκέτι αὐτὸν δύνασθαι φανερῶς εἰς πόλιν εἰσελθεῖν | 1 | so that Jesus was able no longer to enter a town openly | This was the result of the man spreading the news so much. Here, **openly** is a metaphor for “publicly.” Jesus could not enter the towns because many people would crowd around him. Alternate translation: “that Jesus could no longer enter a town publicly” or “that Jesus could no longer enter the towns in a way that many people would see him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
90 | MRK | 1 | 45 | d5lw | ἐρήμοις τόποις | 1 | desolate places | “lonely places” or “places where no one lived” | |
91 | MRK | 1 | 45 | z363 | figs-hyperbole | πάντοθεν | 1 | from all sides | The word **all sides** is a hyperbole used to emphasize how very many places the people came from. Alternate translation: “from all over the region” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
92 | MRK | 2 | intro | zhb5 | 0 | # Mark 02 General Notes<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### “Sinners”<br><br>When the people of Jesus’ time spoke of “sinners,” they were talking about people who did not obey the law of Moses and instead committed sins like stealing or sexual sins. When Jesus said that he came to call “sinners,” he meant that only people who believe that they are sinners can be his followers. This is true even if they are not what most people think of as “sinners.” (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/sin]])<br><br>### Fasting and Feasting<br><br>People would fast, or not eat food for a long time, when they were sad or were showing God that they were sorry for their sins. When they were happy, like during weddings, they would have feasts, or meals where they would eat much food. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/other/fast]])<br><br>## Important figures of speech in this chapter<br><br>### Rhetorical Questions<br><br>The Jewish leaders used rhetorical questions to show that they were angry because of what Jesus said and did and that they did not believe that he was God’s Son ([Mark 2:7](../../mrk/02/07.md)). Jesus used them to show the Jewish leaders that they were arrogant ([Mark 2:25-26](./25.md)). (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) | |||
93 | MRK | 2 | 1 | se22 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After preaching and healing people throughout Galilee, Jesus returns to Capernaum where he heals and forgives the sin of a paralyzed man. | ||
94 | MRK | 2 | 1 | ir5j | figs-activepassive | ἠκούσθη ὅτι ἐν οἴκῳ ἐστίν | 1 | it was heard that he is at home | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the people there heard that he was staying at his home” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
95 | MRK | 2 | 2 | d3iy | figs-explicit | καὶ συνήχθησαν πολλοὶ | 1 | And many gathered | The people **gathered** to the house where Jesus stayed in Capernaum. Alternate translation: “And many people gathered there” or “And many people came to the house” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
96 | MRK | 2 | 2 | e7d4 | figs-explicit | μηκέτι χωρεῖν…τὰ | 1 | there was no more space | This refers to there being no space inside the house. Alternate translation: “there was no more room for them inside the house” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
97 | MRK | 2 | 2 | dps4 | ἐλάλει αὐτοῖς τὸν λόγον | 1 | he was speaking the word to them | “Jesus was speaking his message to them” | |
98 | MRK | 2 | 3 | n643 | αἰρόμενον ὑπὸ τεσσάρων | 1 | being carried by four men | “and four of them were carrying him.” It is likely that there were more than four people within the group that brought the man to Jesus. | |
99 | MRK | 2 | 3 | c1vr | φέροντες…παραλυτικὸν | 1 | bringing a paralyzed man | “bringing a man who was unable to walk or use his arms” | |
100 | MRK | 2 | 4 | h3yn | μὴ δυνάμενοι προσενέγκαι αὐτῷ | 1 | not being able to approach him | “they could not get close to where Jesus was” | |
101 | MRK | 2 | 4 | v6ma | ἀπεστέγασαν τὴν στέγην ὅπου ἦν, καὶ ἐξορύξαντες, χαλῶσι | 1 | they removed the roof where he was, and having made an opening, they lowered | Houses where Jesus lived had flat roofs made of clay and covered with tiles. The process of making a hole in the roof can be explained more clearly or made more general so that it may be understood in your language. Alternate translation: “they removed the tiles from the part of the roof above where Jesus was. And when they had dug through the clay roof, they lowered” or “they made a hole in the roof above where Jesus was, and then they lowered” | |
102 | MRK | 2 | 5 | trg9 | figs-explicit | ἰδὼν…τὴν πίστιν αὐτῶν | 1 | having seen their faith | “Having seen the men’s faith.” This could mean: (1) that only the men who carried the paralyzed man had **faith** or (2) that the paralyzed man and the men who brought him to Jesus all had **faith**. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
103 | MRK | 2 | 5 | hzg6 | figs-metaphor | τέκνον | 1 | Child | The word **Child** here shows Jesus cared for the man as a father cares for a son. Alternate translation: “My son” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
104 | MRK | 2 | 5 | vd3i | ἀφέωνται σου αἱ ἁμαρτίαι | 1 | your sins are forgiven | If possible translate this in such a way that Jesus does not clearly say who forgives the man’s **sins**. Alternate translation: “your sins are gone” or “you do not have to pay for your sins” or “your sins do not count against you” | |
105 | MRK | 2 | 6 | le6v | figs-metonymy | διαλογιζόμενοι ἐν ταῖς καρδίαις αὐτῶν | 1 | reasoning in their hearts | Here, **hearts** is a metonym for the people’s thoughts. Alternate translation: “were thinking to themselves” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
106 | MRK | 2 | 7 | yr5a | figs-rquestion | τί οὗτος οὕτως λαλεῖ? | 1 | Why does this man speak this way? | The scribes used this question to show their anger that Jesus said “Your sins are forgiven.” Alternate translation: “This man should not speak this way!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
107 | MRK | 2 | 7 | sj6j | figs-rquestion | τίς δύναται ἀφιέναι ἁμαρτίας, εἰ μὴ εἷς ὁ Θεός? | 1 | Who is able to forgive sins except God alone? | The scribes used this question to say that since only **God** can **forgive sins**, then Jesus should not say “Your sins are forgiven.” Alternate translation: “Only God can forgive sins!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
108 | MRK | 2 | 8 | niy6 | τῷ πνεύματι αὐτοῦ | 1 | in his spirit | “in his inner being” or “in himself” | |
109 | MRK | 2 | 8 | t87i | οὕτως διαλογίζονται ἐν ἑαυτοῖς | 1 | they were thinking in this manner within themselves | Each of the scribes was thinking to himself; they were not talking to each other. | |
110 | MRK | 2 | 8 | wga7 | figs-rquestion | τί ταῦτα διαλογίζεσθε ἐν ταῖς καρδίαις ὑμῶν? | 1 | Why are you thinking these things in your hearts? | Jesus uses this question to tell the scribes that what they are thinking is wrong. Alternate translation: “What you are thinking is wrong.” or “Do not think that I am blaspheming.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
111 | MRK | 2 | 8 | s3m6 | figs-metonymy | ταῦτα…ἐν ταῖς καρδίαις ὑμῶν | 1 | these things in your hearts | The word **hearts** is a metonym for their inner thoughts and desires. Alternate translation: “this inside yourselves” or “these things” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
112 | MRK | 2 | 9 | wv5d | figs-rquestion | τί ἐστιν εὐκοπώτερον, εἰπεῖν τῷ παραλυτικῷ, ἀφίενταί σου αἱ ἁμαρτίαι, ἢ εἰπεῖν, ἔγειρε καὶ ἆρον τὸν κράβαττόν σου καὶ περιπάτει? | 1 | Which is easier to say to the paralyzed man, ‘Your sins have been forgiven’ or to say ‘Get up and take up your bed, and walk’? | Jesus uses this question to make the scribes think about what might prove whether or not he could really forgive sins. Alternate translation: “I just said to the paralyzed man, ‘Your sins are forgiven.’ You may think that it is harder to say ‘Get up, take up your bed, and walk,’ because the proof of whether or not I can heal him will be shown by whether or not he gets up and walks.” or “You may think that it is easier to say to the paralyzed man ‘Your sins are forgiven’ than it is to say ‘Get up, take up your bed, and walk.’” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
113 | MRK | 2 | 10 | g4jn | ἵνα δὲ εἰδῆτε | 1 | But in order that you may know | “But so that you may know.” The word **you** refers to the scribes and the crowd. | |
114 | MRK | 2 | 10 | jw9z | figs-123person | ὅτι ἐξουσίαν ἔχει ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου | 1 | that the Son of Man has authority | Jesus refers to himself as the “Son of Man.” Alternate translation: “that I am the Son of Man and I have authority” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]]) |
115 | MRK | 2 | 12 | ki94 | ἔμπροσθεν πάντων | 1 | in front of everyone | “while all the people there were watching” | |
116 | MRK | 2 | 13 | ma6f | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus is teaching the crowd beside the Sea of Galilee, and he calls Levi to follow him. | ||
117 | MRK | 2 | 13 | t2sc | τὴν θάλασσαν | 1 | the sea | This is the Sea of Galilee, which is also known as the Lake of Gennesaret. | |
118 | MRK | 2 | 13 | iw43 | ὁ ὄχλος ἤρχετο πρὸς αὐτόν | 1 | the crowd was coming to him | “the people went where he was” | |
119 | MRK | 2 | 14 | sc4g | translate-names | Λευεὶν τὸν τοῦ Ἁλφαίου | 1 | Levi son of Alphaeus | **Alphaeus** was Levi’s father. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
120 | MRK | 2 | 15 | udb2 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | It is now later in the day, and Jesus is at Levi’s house for a meal. | ||
121 | MRK | 2 | 15 | if3i | τῇ οἰκίᾳ αὐτοῦ | 1 | his house | “the home of Levi” | |
122 | MRK | 2 | 15 | qf38 | ἁμαρτωλοὶ | 1 | sinners | people who did not obey the law of Moses but committed what others thought were very bad sins | |
123 | MRK | 2 | 15 | bwv2 | ἦσαν γὰρ πολλοὶ, καὶ ἠκολούθουν αὐτῷ | 1 | for there were many and they were following him | This could mean: (1) “for there were many tax collectors and sinful people who followed Jesus” or (2) “for Jesus had many disciples and they followed him.” | |
124 | MRK | 2 | 16 | b1bi | figs-rquestion | ὅτι μετὰ τῶν τελωνῶν καὶ ἁμαρτωλῶν ἐσθίει? | 1 | Why is he eating with the tax collectors and sinners? | The scribes and Pharisees asked this question to show they disapproved of Jesus’ hospitality. This can be worded as a statement. Alternate translation: “He should not eat with sinners and tax collectors!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
125 | MRK | 2 | 17 | ba3n | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus responds to what the scribes had said to his disciples about his eating with tax collectors and sinful people. | ||
126 | MRK | 2 | 17 | q8r6 | λέγει αὐτοῖς | 1 | said to them | “he said to the scribes” | |
127 | MRK | 2 | 17 | ak1u | writing-proverbs | οὐ χρείαν ἔχουσιν οἱ ἰσχύοντες ἰατροῦ, ἀλλ’ οἱ κακῶς ἔχοντες | 1 | The ones being healthy do not have need of a physician, but the ones having sickness | Jesus used this proverb about sick people and doctors to teach them that only people who know that they are sinful realize that they need Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]]) |
128 | MRK | 2 | 17 | ca8h | figs-irony | οὐκ ἦλθον καλέσαι δικαίους, ἀλλὰ ἁμαρτωλούς | 1 | I came not to call the righteous, but sinners | Jesus expects his hearers to understand he came for those who want help. Alternate translation: “I came for people who understand they are sinful, not for people who believe they are righteous” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]]) |
129 | MRK | 2 | 17 | ca4e | figs-ellipsis | ἀλλὰ ἁμαρτωλούς | 1 | but sinners | The words “I came to call” are understood from the phrase before this. Alternate translation: “but I came to call sinners” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
130 | MRK | 2 | 18 | zkz9 | figs-parables | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus tells parables to show why his disciples should not fast while he is with them. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]]) | |
131 | MRK | 2 | 18 | f1ds | ἦσαν…οἱ Φαρισαῖοι νηστεύοντες…οἱ μαθηταὶ τῶν Φαρισαίων | 1 | the Pharisees were fasting … the disciples of the Pharisees | These two phrases refer to the same group of people, but the second is more specific. Both refer to the followers of the Pharisee sect, but they do not focus on the leaders of the Pharisees. Alternate translation: “the disciples of the Pharisees were fasting … the disciples of the Pharisees” | |
132 | MRK | 2 | 18 | z394 | ἔρχονται | 1 | they are coming | “some men are coming.” It is best to translate this phrase without specifying exactly who these men are. If in your language you have to be more specific, this could mean: (1) these men were not among John’s disciples or the disciples of the Pharisees or (2) these men were among John’s disciples. | |
133 | MRK | 2 | 18 | vl3z | ἔρχονται καὶ λέγουσιν αὐτῷ | 1 | they are coming and saying to him | “they came and said to Jesus” | |
134 | MRK | 2 | 19 | eke3 | figs-rquestion | μὴ δύνανται οἱ υἱοὶ τοῦ νυμφῶνος ἐν ᾧ ὁ νυμφίος μετ’ αὐτῶν ἐστιν νηστεύειν? | 1 | The sons of the wedding chamber are not able to fast while the bridegroom is still with them, are they? | Jesus uses this question to remind the people of something they already know and to encourage them to apply it to him and his disciples. Alternate translation: “Wedding attendants do not fast while the bridegroom is with them. Rather they celebrate and feast.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
135 | MRK | 2 | 20 | vg2u | figs-activepassive | ἀπαρθῇ…ὁ νυμφίος | 1 | the bridegroom may be taken away | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the bridegroom will go away” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
136 | MRK | 2 | 20 | c7ik | ἀπαρθῇ ἀπ’ αὐτῶν…νηστεύσουσιν | 1 | may be taken away from them … they will fast | The word **them** and **they** refer to the wedding attendants. | |
137 | MRK | 2 | 21 | v6xc | figs-explicit | οὐδεὶς ἐπίβλημα ῥάκους ἀγνάφου ἐπιράπτει ἐπὶ ἱμάτιον παλαιόν | 1 | No one sews a patch of unshrunk cloth on an old garment | Sewing a piece of new **cloth** on an old garment will make the hole on an old garment worse if the piece of new cloth has not yet shrunk. Both the new cloth and **old garment** will be ruined. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
138 | MRK | 2 | 22 | dw15 | figs-parables | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus begins to tell another parable. This one is about putting new wine into old wineskins rather than into new wineskins. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]]) | |
139 | MRK | 2 | 22 | y7rw | οἶνον νέον | 1 | new wine | “grape juice.” This refers to **wine** that has not fermented yet. If grapes are unknown in your area, use the general term for fruit juice. | |
140 | MRK | 2 | 22 | n7ha | ἀσκοὺς παλαιούς | 1 | old wineskins | This refers to **wineskins** that have been used many times. | |
141 | MRK | 2 | 22 | fk15 | ἀσκοὺς | 1 | wineskins | These were bags made out of animal skins. They could also be called “wine bags” or “skin bags.” | |
142 | MRK | 2 | 22 | w35r | ῥήξει ὁ οἶνος τοὺς ἀσκούς | 1 | the wine will burst the wineskins | New **wine** expands as it ferments, so it would cause old, brittle **wineskins** to tear open. | |
143 | MRK | 2 | 22 | bef2 | ἀπόλλυται | 1 | will be destroyed | “will be ruined” | |
144 | MRK | 2 | 22 | c9z6 | ἀσκοὺς καινούς | 1 | fresh wineskins | “new wineskins” or “new wine bags.” This refers to **wineskins** that have never been used. | |
145 | MRK | 2 | 23 | t8ni | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus gives the Pharisees an example from scripture to show why the disciples were not wrong to pick grain on the Sabbath. | ||
146 | MRK | 2 | 23 | jya1 | figs-explicit | τίλλοντες τοὺς στάχυας | 1 | picking the heads of grain | Plucking grain in others’ fields and eating it was not considered stealing. The question was whether it was lawful to do this on the Sabbath. The disciples were **picking the heads of grain** to eat the kernels, or seeds, in them. This can be worded to show the full meaning. Alternate translation: “picking heads of grain and eating the seeds” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
147 | MRK | 2 | 23 | k3pa | τοὺς στάχυας | 1 | the heads of grain | The **heads** are the topmost part of the wheat plant, which is a kind of tall grass. The heads hold the mature grain or seeds of the plant. | |
148 | MRK | 2 | 24 | ng1d | 0 | Connecting Statement: | The Pharisees ask a question about what the disciples were doing (verse 23). | ||
149 | MRK | 2 | 24 | x5ll | ποιοῦσιν τοῖς Σάββασιν ὃ οὐκ ἔξεστιν | 1 | are they doing what is not lawful on the Sabbaths | Plucking grain in others’ fields and eating it (verse 23) was not considered stealing. The question was whether it was **lawful** to do this on the Sabbath. | |
150 | MRK | 2 | 24 | h41a | figs-rquestion | ἴδε, τί ποιοῦσιν τοῖς Σάββασιν ὃ οὐκ ἔξεστιν? | 1 | Look, why are they doing what is not lawful on the Sabbaths? | The Pharisees ask Jesus a question to condemn him. This can be translated as a statement. Alternate translation: “Look! They are breaking the Jewish law concerning the Sabbaths.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
151 | MRK | 2 | 24 | bf8w | ἴδε | 1 | Look | “Look at this” or “Listen.” This is a word used to get the attention of someone to show them something. If there is a word in your language that is used to draw a person’s attention to something, you could use that here. | |
152 | MRK | 2 | 25 | dd1z | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus begins to scold the Pharisees by asking them a question. | ||
153 | MRK | 2 | 25 | g1xw | λέγει αὐτοῖς | 1 | he said to them | “Jesus said to the Pharisees” | |
154 | MRK | 2 | 25 | d236 | figs-rquestion | οὐδέποτε ἀνέγνωτε τί ἐποίησεν Δαυεὶδ…οἱ μετ’ αὐτοῦ? | 1 | Have you never read what David did when he had need and was hungry—he and the ones with him— | Jesus asks this question to remind the scribes and Pharisees of something **David did** on the Sabbath. The question is very long, so it can be divided into two sentences. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
155 | MRK | 2 | 25 | g8sf | figs-rquestion | οὐδέποτε ἀνέγνωτε τί ἐποίησεν Δαυεὶδ | 1 | Have you never read what David did | This can be stated as a command. Alternate translation: “Remember what you read about what David did” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
156 | MRK | 2 | 25 | r14d | figs-explicit | οὐδέποτε ἀνέγνωτε τί ἐποίησεν Δαυεὶδ | 1 | Have you never read what David did | Jesus refers to reading about David in the Old Testament. This can be translated showing the implicit information. Alternate translation: “Have you not read in the scriptures what David did” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
157 | MRK | 2 | 26 | x3bb | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus finishes asking the question he began in verse 25. | ||
158 | MRK | 2 | 26 | zmd3 | figs-rquestion | πῶς εἰσῆλθεν εἰς τὸν οἶκον τοῦ Θεοῦ…τοῖς σὺν αὐτῷ οὖσιν? | 1 | how he went into the house of God during Abiathar the high priest, and ate the bread of the presence, which is not lawful to eat, except for the priests, and he also gave some to those being with him? | This can be expressed as a statement separate from verse 25. Alternate translation: “He went into the house of God during Abiathar the high priest, and ate the bread of the presence, which is not lawful to eat, except for the priests, and he also gave some to those being with him.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
159 | MRK | 2 | 26 | al82 | πῶς εἰσῆλθεν | 1 | how he went | The word **he** refers to David. | |
160 | MRK | 2 | 26 | y57j | τοὺς ἄρτους τῆς Προθέσεως | 1 | the bread of the presence | This refers to the 12 loaves of **bread** that were placed on a golden table in the tabernacle or temple building as a sacrifice to God during Old Testament times. | |
161 | MRK | 2 | 27 | i374 | figs-activepassive | τὸ Σάββατον διὰ τὸν ἄνθρωπον ἐγένετο | 1 | The Sabbath was made for man | Jesus makes clear why God established the Sabbath. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God made the Sabbath for mankind” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
162 | MRK | 2 | 27 | u83s | figs-gendernotations | τὸν ἄνθρωπον | 1 | man | “mankind” or “people” or “the needs of people.” This word here refers to both men and women. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-gendernotations]]) |
163 | MRK | 2 | 27 | s2yd | figs-ellipsis | οὐχ ὁ ἄνθρωπος διὰ τὸ Σάββατον | 1 | not man for the Sabbath | The words **was made** are understood from the previous phrase. They can be repeated here. Alternate translation: “man was not made for the Sabbath” or “God did not make man for the Sabbath” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
164 | MRK | 3 | intro | x969 | 0 | # Mark 03 General Notes<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### Sabbath<br><br>It was against the law of Moses to do work on the Sabbath. The Pharisees believed healing a sick person on the Sabbath was “work,” so they said that Jesus did wrong when he healed a person on the Sabbath. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/lawofmoses]])<br><br>### “Blasphemy against the Spirit”<br><br>No one knows for sure what actions people perform or what words they say when they commit this sin. However, they probably insult the Holy Spirit and his work. Part of the Holy Spirit’s work is to make people understand that they are sinners and that they need to have God forgive them. Therefore, anyone who does not try to stop sinning is probably committing blasphemy against the Spirit. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/blasphemy]] and [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/holyspirit]])<br><br>## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter<br><br>### The twelve disciples<br><br>The following are the lists of the twelve disciples:<br><br>In Matthew:<br><br>Simon (Peter), Andrew, James son of Zebedee, John son of Zebedee, Philip, Bartholomew, Thomas, Matthew, James son of Alphaeus, Thaddaeus, Simon the Zealot and Judas Iscariot.<br><br>In Mark:<br><br>Simon (Peter), Andrew, James the son of Zebedee and John the son of Zebedee (to whom he gave the name Boanerges, that is, sons of thunder), Philip, Bartholomew, Matthew, Thomas, James the son of Alphaeus, Thaddaeus, Simon the Zealot, and Judas Iscariot.<br><br>In Luke:<br><br>Simon (Peter), Andrew, James, John, Philip, Bartholomew, Matthew, Thomas, James the son of Alphaeus, Simon (who was called the Zealot), Judas the son of James, and Judas Iscariot.<br><br>Thaddaeus is probably the same person as Jude, the son of James.<br><br>### Brothers and Sisters<br><br>Most people call those who have the same parents “brother” and “sister” and think of them as the most important people in their lives. Many people also call those with the same grandparents “brother” and “sister.” In this chapter Jesus says that the most important people to him are those who obey God. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/brother]]) | |||
165 | MRK | 3 | 1 | cp3e | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus heals a man on the Sabbath in the synagogue and shows how he feels about what the Pharisees had done with the Sabbath rules. The Pharisees and Herodians begin to plan to put Jesus to death. | ||
166 | MRK | 3 | 1 | y5l9 | ἄνθρωπος, ἐξηραμμένην ἔχων τὴν χεῖρα | 1 | a man having a withered hand | “a man with a crippled hand” | |
167 | MRK | 3 | 2 | v2yj | παρετήρουν αὐτὸν, εἰ τοῖς Σάββασιν θεραπεύσει αὐτόν | 1 | they were watching him closely, if he will heal him on the Sabbath | “some people watched Jesus closely to see if he would heal the man with the withered hand on the Sabbath day” | |
168 | MRK | 3 | 2 | n5iz | παρετήρουν αὐτὸν | 1 | they were watching him closely | “some of the Pharisees were watching him closely.” Later, in [Mark 3:6](../03/06.md), these people are identified as Pharisees. | |
169 | MRK | 3 | 2 | vr25 | figs-explicit | ἵνα κατηγορήσωσιν αὐτοῦ | 1 | so that they might accuse him | If Jesus were to heal the man that day, the Pharisees would **accuse him** of breaking the law by the working on the Sabbath. Alternate translation: “so that they could accuse him of wrongdoing” or “so that they could accuse him of breaking the law” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
170 | MRK | 3 | 3 | nm6w | εἰς τὸ μέσον | 1 | in our midst | “in the middle of this crowd” | |
171 | MRK | 3 | 4 | mh3z | figs-rquestion | ἔξεστιν τοῖς Σάββασιν ἀγαθοποιῆσαι ἢ κακοποιῆσαι, ψυχὴν σῶσαι ἢ ἀποκτεῖναι? | 1 | Is it lawful on the Sabbaths to do good, or to do harm; to save a life, or to kill? | Jesus said this to challenge them. He wanted them to acknowledge that it is **lawful** to heal people on the Sabbath. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
172 | MRK | 3 | 4 | i71v | figs-parallelism | ἀγαθοποιῆσαι ἢ κακοποιῆσαι, ψυχὴν σῶσαι ἢ ἀποκτεῖναι | 1 | to do good, or to do harm … to save a life, or to kill | These two phrases are similar in meaning, except that the second is more extreme. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]]) |
173 | MRK | 3 | 4 | vz6c | figs-ellipsis | ψυχὴν σῶσαι ἢ ἀποκτεῖναι | 1 | to save a life, or to kill | It may be helpful to repeat “is it lawful,” as that is the question Jesus is asking again in another way. Alternate translation: “is it lawful to save a life, or to kill” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
174 | MRK | 3 | 4 | nut4 | figs-metonymy | ψυχὴν | 1 | a life | This refers to physical life and is a metonym for a person. Alternate translation: “someone from dying” or “someone’s life” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
175 | MRK | 3 | 4 | w683 | οἱ δὲ ἐσιώπων | 1 | But they were keeping silent | “But they refused to answer him” | |
176 | MRK | 3 | 5 | vr8q | περιβλεψάμενος | 1 | having looked around | “after Jesus had looked around” | |
177 | MRK | 3 | 5 | nkk8 | συνλυπούμενος | 1 | being grieved | “being deeply saddened” | |
178 | MRK | 3 | 5 | xwp9 | figs-metaphor | ἐπὶ τῇ πωρώσει τῆς καρδίας αὐτῶν | 1 | by the hardness of their heart | This metaphor describes how the Pharisees were unwilling to have compassion on the man with the withered hand. Alternate translation: “because they were unwilling to have compassion on the man” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
179 | MRK | 3 | 5 | e7fz | ἔκτεινον τὴν χεῖρα σου | 1 | Stretch out your hand | “Reach out with your hand” | |
180 | MRK | 3 | 5 | c3qe | figs-activepassive | ἀπεκατεστάθη ἡ χεὶρ αὐτοῦ | 1 | his hand was restored | This can be stated with an active form. Alternate translation: “Jesus restored his hand” or “Jesus made his hand the way it was before” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
181 | MRK | 3 | 6 | dy5j | συμβούλιον ἐποίουν | 1 | were making counsel | “began to make a plan” | |
182 | MRK | 3 | 6 | nvk1 | τῶν Ἡρῳδιανῶν | 1 | the Herodians | This is the name of an informal political party that supported Herod Antipas. | |
183 | MRK | 3 | 6 | gjw2 | ὅπως αὐτὸν ἀπολέσωσιν | 1 | as to how they might kill him | “how they might kill Jesus” | |
184 | MRK | 3 | 7 | c13n | 0 | Connecting Statement: | A great crowd of people follows Jesus, and he heals many people. | ||
185 | MRK | 3 | 7 | h2v6 | τὴν θάλασσαν | 1 | the sea | This refers to the Sea of Galilee. | |
186 | MRK | 3 | 8 | bi1b | τῆς Ἰδουμαίας | 1 | Idumea | This is the region, previously known as Edom, which covered the southern half of the province of Judea. | |
187 | MRK | 3 | 8 | mm5v | ὅσα ἐποίει | 1 | how much he was doing | This refers to the miracles Jesus was performing. Alternate translation: “the great miracles that Jesus was performing” | |
188 | MRK | 3 | 8 | gra8 | ἦλθον πρὸς αὐτόν | 1 | came to him | “came to where Jesus was” | |
189 | MRK | 3 | 9 | q65h | figs-events | 0 | General Information: | Verse 9 tells what Jesus asked his disciples to do because of the large crowd of people around him. Verse 10 tells why such a large crowd was around Jesus. The information in these verses can be reordered to present the events in the order they happened, as in the UST. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-events]]) | |
190 | MRK | 3 | 9 | zu5e | εἶπεν τοῖς μαθηταῖς αὐτοῦ, ἵνα πλοιάριον προσκαρτερῇ αὐτῷ διὰ τὸν ὄχλον, ἵνα μὴ θλίβωσιν αὐτόν | 1 | he said to his disciples that a small boat should be waiting for him because of the crowd, so that they would not press against him | As the large **crowd** was pushing forward toward Jesus, he was in danger of being crushed by them. They would not crush him intentionally. It was just that there were so many people. | |
191 | MRK | 3 | 10 | e86s | grammar-connect-words-phrases | πολλοὺς γὰρ ἐθεράπευσεν, ὥστε ἐπιπίπτειν αὐτῷ, ἵνα αὐτοῦ ἅψωνται ὅσοι εἶχον μάστιγας | 1 | For he healed many, so that as many as had diseases pressed against him so that they might touch him | This tells why so many people were crowding around Jesus that he thought they might crush him. Alternate translation: “For, because Jesus had healed many people, everyone pressed against him so that they might touch him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/grammar-connect-words-phrases]]) |
192 | MRK | 3 | 10 | ei4n | figs-ellipsis | πολλοὺς γὰρ ἐθεράπευσεν | 1 | For he healed many | The word **many** refers to the large number of people Jesus had already healed. Alternate translation: “For he healed many people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
193 | MRK | 3 | 10 | ge71 | figs-explicit | ἐπιπίπτειν αὐτῷ, ἵνα αὐτοῦ ἅψωνται ὅσοι εἶχον μάστιγας | 1 | as many as had diseases pressed against him so that they might touch him | They did this because they believed that touching Jesus would make them well. This can be expressed clearly. Alternate translation: “all the sick people pushed forward eagerly trying to touch him so that they might be healed” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
194 | MRK | 3 | 11 | g1r5 | αὐτὸν ἐθεώρουν | 1 | saw him | “saw Jesus” | |
195 | MRK | 3 | 11 | ca5i | figs-explicit | προσέπιπτον αὐτῷ καὶ ἔκραζον λέγοντα | 1 | they were falling down before him and crying out, saying | Here, **they** refers to the unclean spirits. It is they who are causing the people they possess to do things. This can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “they caused the people they were possessing to fall down before him and to cry out to him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
196 | MRK | 3 | 11 | mcr9 | προσέπιπτον αὐτῷ | 1 | they were falling down before him | The unclean spirits were not **falling down before** Jesus because they loved him or wanted to worship him. They fell down before him because they were afraid of him. | |
197 | MRK | 3 | 11 | xjy4 | σὺ εἶ ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Θεοῦ | 1 | You are the Son of God | Jesus has power over unclean spirits because he is the **Son of God**. | |
198 | MRK | 3 | 11 | xf41 | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Θεοῦ | 1 | the Son of God | This is an important title for Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
199 | MRK | 3 | 12 | ay6j | πολλὰ ἐπετίμα αὐτοῖς | 1 | he was often rebuking them | “Jesus often strictly ordered the unclean spirits” | |
200 | MRK | 3 | 12 | npi9 | μὴ αὐτὸν φανερὸν ποιήσωσιν | 1 | they would not make him known | “they would not reveal who he was” | |
201 | MRK | 3 | 13 | ue15 | 0 | General Information: | Jesus chooses the men he wants to be his apostles. | ||
202 | MRK | 3 | 14 | xc5r | ἵνα ὦσιν μετ’ αὐτοῦ, καὶ ἵνα ἀποστέλλῃ αὐτοὺς κηρύσσειν | 1 | so that they might be with him and so that he might send them to preach | “so that they would be with him and he would send them to proclaim the message” | |
203 | MRK | 3 | 16 | i7tf | καὶ ἐπέθηκεν ὄνομα τῷ Σίμωνι, Πέτρον | 1 | To Simon, also he added the name Peter | The author begins to list the names of the twelve apostles. **Simon** is the first man listed. | |
204 | MRK | 3 | 17 | cj3v | καὶ ἐπέθηκεν αὐτοῖς | 1 | to whom he also added | The phrase **to whom** refers to both James son of Zebedee and his brother John. | |
205 | MRK | 3 | 17 | n4gy | translate-names | ὀνόματα Βοανηργές, ὅ ἐστιν υἱοὶ βροντῆς | 1 | the name Boanerges, that is, sons of thunder | Jesus called them this because they were like **thunder**. Alternate translation: “the name Boanerges, which means men who are like thunder” or “the name Boanerges, which means thunder men” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
206 | MRK | 3 | 18 | mq9b | translate-names | Θαδδαῖον | 1 | Thaddaeus | This is the name of a man. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
207 | MRK | 3 | 19 | r3zs | ὃς καὶ παρέδωκεν αὐτόν | 1 | who also betrayed him | “who would betray Jesus” The word **who** refers to Judas Iscariot. | |
208 | MRK | 3 | 20 | jxr5 | καὶ ἔρχεται εἰς οἶκον | 1 | And he is entering into a house | “Then Jesus went to the house where he was staying.” | |
209 | MRK | 3 | 20 | rq6k | figs-synecdoche | μὴ δύνασθαι αὐτοὺς μηδὲ ἄρτον φαγεῖν | 1 | they are not able even to eat bread | The word **bread** represents food. Alternate translation: “Jesus and his disciples could not eat at all” or “they could not eat anything” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
210 | MRK | 3 | 21 | bk6g | ἐξῆλθον κρατῆσαι αὐτόν | 1 | went out to seize him | Members of his family went to the house, so that they could take hold of him and force him to go home with them. | |
211 | MRK | 3 | 21 | uyl8 | ἔλεγον γὰρ | 1 | for they said | Here, **they** could mean: (1) his relatives or (2) some people in the crowd. | |
212 | MRK | 3 | 21 | mf5q | figs-idiom | ἐξέστη | 1 | He is out of his mind | Jesus’ family uses this idiom to describe how they think he is acting. Alternate translation: “He is crazy” or “He is insane” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
213 | MRK | 3 | 22 | yxd9 | ἐν τῷ ἄρχοντι τῶν δαιμονίων, ἐκβάλλει τὰ δαιμόνια | 1 | By the ruler of the demons he is casting out demons | “By the power of Beelzebul, who is the ruler of the demons, Jesus drives out demons” | |
214 | MRK | 3 | 23 | ji69 | figs-parables | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus explains with a parable why it is foolish for people to think that Jesus is controlled by Satan. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]]) | |
215 | MRK | 3 | 23 | gcy5 | προσκαλεσάμενος αὐτοὺς | 1 | having called them to himself | “When Jesus had called the people to come to him” | |
216 | MRK | 3 | 23 | q8f3 | figs-rquestion | πῶς δύναται Σατανᾶς Σατανᾶν ἐκβάλλειν? | 1 | How is Satan able to cast out Satan? | Jesus asked this rhetorical question in response to the scribes saying that he **cast out** demons by Beelzebul. This question can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “Satan cannot cast out himself!” or “Satan does not go against his own evil spirits!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
217 | MRK | 3 | 24 | b4z4 | figs-metonymy | ἐὰν βασιλεία ἐφ’ ἑαυτὴν μερισθῇ | 1 | if a kingdom might have been divided against itself | The word **kingdom** is a metonym for the people who live in the **kingdom**. Alternate translation: “If the people who live in a kingdom are divided against each other” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
218 | MRK | 3 | 24 | k3bz | figs-metaphor | οὐ δύναται σταθῆναι | 1 | is not able to stand | This phrase is a metaphor meaning that the people will no longer be united and they will fall. Alternate translation: “cannot endure” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
219 | MRK | 3 | 24 | h7hr | figs-litotes | οὐ δύναται σταθῆναι | 1 | is not able to stand | This phrase can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “will fall”(See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]]) |
220 | MRK | 3 | 25 | zcr1 | figs-metonymy | οἰκία | 1 | a house | This is a metonym for the people who live in **a house**. Alternate translation: “a family” or “a household” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
221 | MRK | 3 | 26 | w7na | figs-rpronouns | εἰ ὁ Σατανᾶς ἀνέστη ἐφ’ ἑαυτὸν καὶ ἐμερίσθη | 1 | if Satan rose up against himself and was divided | The word **himself** is a reflexive pronoun that refers back to Satan. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rpronouns]]) |
222 | MRK | 3 | 26 | xdi5 | figs-metonymy | εἰ ὁ Σατανᾶς ἀνέστη ἐφ’ ἑαυτὸν καὶ ἐμερίσθη | 1 | if Satan rose up against himself and was divided | Here, **Satan** is a metonym for his evil spirits. Alternate translation: “If Satan and his evil spirits were fighting one another” or “If Satan and his evil spirits have risen up against each other and are divided” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
223 | MRK | 3 | 26 | df2f | figs-metaphor | οὐ δύναται στῆναι, ἀλλὰ τέλος ἔχει | 1 | he is not able to stand, but he has an end | This is a metaphor meaning he will fall and cannot endure. Alternate translation: “he will cease to be united and will be finished” or “he cannot endure and has come to an end” or “he will fall and has come to an end” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
224 | MRK | 3 | 27 | mvr6 | διαρπάσει | 1 | he will plunder | to steal a person’s valuables and possessions | |
225 | MRK | 3 | 28 | f6fq | ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν | 1 | Truly I say to you | This indicates that the statement that follows is especially true and important. | |
226 | MRK | 3 | 28 | p6sz | τοῖς υἱοῖς τῶν ἀνθρώπων | 1 | of the sons of men | “of those who have been born of man.” This expression is used to emphasize peoples’ humanity. Alternate translation: “people” | |
227 | MRK | 3 | 28 | rf7r | βλασφημήσωσιν | 1 | they may blaspheme | speak | |
228 | MRK | 3 | 30 | cm47 | ἔλεγον | 1 | they were saying | “the people were saying” | |
229 | MRK | 3 | 30 | sfa2 | figs-idiom | πνεῦμα ἀκάθαρτον ἔχει | 1 | He has an unclean spirit | This is an idiom that means to be possessed by **an unclean spirit**. Alternate translation: “is possessed by an unclean spirit” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
230 | MRK | 3 | 31 | gef8 | καὶ ἔρχονται ἡ μήτηρ αὐτοῦ καὶ οἱ ἀδελφοὶ αὐτοῦ | 1 | Then his mother and his brothers come | “Then Jesus’ mother and brothers came” | |
231 | MRK | 3 | 31 | h5zr | ἀπέστειλαν πρὸς αὐτὸν καλοῦντες αὐτόν | 1 | they sent to him, summoning him | “they sent someone inside to tell him that they were outside and to have him come out to them” | |
232 | MRK | 3 | 32 | wms6 | ζητοῦσίν σε | 1 | seeking you | “asking for you” | |
233 | MRK | 3 | 33 | qe8c | figs-rquestion | τίς ἐστιν ἡ μήτηρ μου, καὶ οἱ ἀδελφοί μου? | 1 | Who are my mother and my brothers? | Jesus uses this question to teach the people. Alternate translation: “I will tell you who are really my mother and brothers” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
234 | MRK | 3 | 35 | dr45 | ὃς…ἂν ποιήσῃ…οὗτος…ἐστίν | 1 | whoever may do … this is | “those who do … they are” | |
235 | MRK | 3 | 35 | yr9i | figs-metaphor | οὗτος ἀδελφός μου καὶ ἀδελφὴ καὶ μήτηρ ἐστίν | 1 | this is my brother, and sister, and mother | This is a metaphor that means Jesus’ disciples belong to Jesus’ spiritual family. This is more important than belonging to his physical family. Alternate translation: “that person is like a brother, sister, or mother to me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
236 | MRK | 4 | intro | f5ua | 0 | # Mark 04 General Notes<br><br>## Structure and formatting<br><br>Mark 4:3-10 forms one parable. The parable is explained in 4:14-23.<br><br>Some translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 4:12, which are words from the Old Testament.<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### Parables<br><br>The parables were short stories that Jesus told so that people would easily understand the lesson he was trying to teach them. He also told the stories so that those who did not want to believe in him would not understand the truth. | |||
237 | MRK | 4 | 1 | a6pk | figs-parables | 0 | Connecting Statement: | As Jesus taught from a boat at the seaside, he told them the parable of the soils. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]]) | |
238 | MRK | 4 | 1 | i95e | τὴν θάλασσαν | 1 | the sea | This is the Sea of Galilee. | |
239 | MRK | 4 | 3 | vqh3 | ἀκούετε! ἰδοὺ…ὁ σπείρων | 1 | Listen! Behold, the sower | “Pay attention! A farmer” | |
240 | MRK | 4 | 4 | si37 | ἐν τῷ σπείρειν, ὃ μὲν ἔπεσεν παρὰ τὴν ὁδόν | 1 | as he sowed, some fell beside the road | “as he threw seed over the soil some fell along the path.” In different cultures people sow seeds differently. In this parable the seeds were sown by throwing the seeds over the land that was prepared for growing. | |
241 | MRK | 4 | 4 | s95n | κατέφαγεν αὐτό | 1 | devoured it | Here, **it** refers to all of the the seeds that the farmer sowed as if they are one seed. Alternate translation: “devoured them” | |
242 | MRK | 4 | 5 | w853 | οὐκ εἶχεν…ἐξανέτειλεν…τὸ μὴ ἔχειν | 1 | it did not have … it sprang … it did not have | Here, **it** refers to all of the the seeds that the farmer sowed as if they are one seed. “they did not have … they sprang … they did not have” | |
243 | MRK | 4 | 5 | px9w | ἐξανέτειλεν | 1 | it sprang up | “the seed that landed on the rocky soil began to grow quickly” | |
244 | MRK | 4 | 5 | le2a | γῆν | 1 | soil | This refers to the loose dirt on the ground in which you can plant seeds. | |
245 | MRK | 4 | 6 | ee49 | figs-activepassive | ἐκαυματίσθη | 1 | it was scorched | This refers to the young plants that sprouted from the seeds. This may be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “it scorched the young plants” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
246 | MRK | 4 | 6 | hht3 | διὰ τὸ μὴ ἔχειν ῥίζαν ἐξηράνθη | 1 | because it had no root, it was dried up | “because the young plants had no roots, they dried up” | |
247 | MRK | 4 | 7 | bw62 | συνέπνιξαν αὐτό…οὐκ ἔδωκεν | 1 | choked it … it did not produce | Here, **it** refers to all of the the seeds that the farmer sowed as if they are one seed. See how you translated this in [Mark 4:3](../04/03.md). “choked them … they did not produce” | |
248 | MRK | 4 | 8 | v3sr | figs-ellipsis | αὐξανόμενα, καὶ ἔφερεν εἰς τριάκοντα, καὶ ἓν ἑξήκοντα, καὶ ἓν ἑκατόν | 1 | increasing and yielding one, 30, and one, 60, and one, 100 | The amount of grain produced by each plant is being compared to the single seed from which it grew. Ellipsis is used here to shorten the phrases but they can be written out. Alternate translation: “Some plants bore 30 times as much as the seed that the man had planted, some produced 60 times as much grain, and some produced 100 times as much grain” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
249 | MRK | 4 | 8 | u327 | translate-numbers | τριάκοντα…ἑξήκοντα…ἑκατόν | 1 | 30 … 60 … 100 | “thirty … sixty … a hundred.” These may be written as numerals. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
250 | MRK | 4 | 9 | p2us | figs-metonymy | ὃς ἔχει ὦτα ἀκούειν, ἀκουέτω | 1 | Whoever has ears to hear, let him hear | Jesus is emphasizing that what he has just said is important and may take some effort to understand and put into practice. The phrase **has ears** here is a metonym for the willingness to understand and obey. Alternate translation: “Whoever is willing to listen, listen” or “Whoever is willing to understand, let him understand and obey” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
251 | MRK | 4 | 9 | qxy4 | figs-123person | ὃς ἔχει ὦτα ἀκούειν, ἀκουέτω | 1 | Whoever has ears to hear, let him hear | Since Jesus is speaking directly to his audience, you may prefer to use the second person here. Alternate translation: “If you are willing to listen, listen” or “If you are willing to understand, then understand and obey” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]]) |
252 | MRK | 4 | 10 | u2nj | ὅτε ἐγένετο κατὰ μόνας | 1 | when he was alone | This does not mean that Jesus was completely **alone**; rather, that the crowds were gone and Jesus was only with the twelve and some of his other close followers. | |
253 | MRK | 4 | 11 | t9ee | figs-activepassive | ὑμῖν…δέδοται | 1 | To you has been given | This can be stated in active form. “God has given you” or “I have given you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
254 | MRK | 4 | 11 | q2az | ἐκείνοις…τοῖς ἔξω | 1 | to those who are outside | “but to those who are not among you.” This refers to all the other people who were not among the twelve or Jesus’ other close followers. | |
255 | MRK | 4 | 11 | daw3 | figs-ellipsis | ἐν παραβολαῖς τὰ πάντα γίνεται | 1 | everything is in parables | It can be stated that Jesus gives the **parables** to the people. Alternate translation: “I have spoken everything in parables” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
256 | MRK | 4 | 12 | aj7t | figs-explicit | βλέποντες…ἀκούοντες | 1 | looking … hearing | It is assumed that Jesus is speaking about the people **looking** at what he shows them and **hearing** what he tells them. Alternate translation: “when they look at what I am doing … when they hear what I am saying” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
257 | MRK | 4 | 12 | p4fv | figs-metaphor | βλέπωσι καὶ μὴ ἴδωσιν | 1 | they may look, but may not see | Jesus speaks of people understanding what they see as actually seeing. Alternate translation: “they look and do not understand” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
258 | MRK | 4 | 12 | p9yr | figs-metaphor | μήποτε ἐπιστρέψωσιν | 1 | so that they would not turn | “so that they would not turn to God.” Here, **turn** is a metaphor for “repent.” Alternate translation: “so that they would not repent” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
259 | MRK | 4 | 13 | xc29 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus explains the parable of the soils to his followers and then tells them about using a lamp to show that hidden things will become known. | ||
260 | MRK | 4 | 13 | qzt4 | καὶ λέγει αὐτοῖς | 1 | And he was saying to them | “And Jesus said to his disciples” | |
261 | MRK | 4 | 13 | fs1v | figs-rquestion | οὐκ οἴδατε τὴν παραβολὴν ταύτην, καὶ πῶς πάσας τὰς παραβολὰς γνώσεσθε? | 1 | Do you not understand this parable? And how will you understand all the parables? | Jesus used these questions to show how sad he was that his disciples could not understand his parable. Alternate translation: “If you cannot understand this parable, think about how hard it will be for you to understand all the other parables.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
262 | MRK | 4 | 14 | zu7y | ὁ σπείρων | 1 | The sower | “The farmer who sows his seed” | |
263 | MRK | 4 | 14 | rp6h | figs-metonymy | τὸν λόγον σπείρει | 1 | sows the word | Here, **the word** represents God’s message. Alternate translation: “the one who sows God’s message” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
264 | MRK | 4 | 14 | xdaj | figs-metaphor | τὸν λόγον σπείρει | 1 | sows the word | Sowing the message represents teaching it. Alternate translation: “the one who teaches people God’s message” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
265 | MRK | 4 | 15 | cy3i | οὗτοι δέ εἰσιν οἱ παρὰ τὴν ὁδὸν | 1 | But these are the ones beside the road | “In some people, the word is like the seeds that fall beside road” or “Some people are like the path where some of the seeds fell” | |
266 | MRK | 4 | 15 | yf39 | τὴν ὁδὸν | 1 | the road | “the path” | |
267 | MRK | 4 | 15 | q5th | ὅταν ἀκούσωσιν | 1 | when they might have heard it | Here, **it** refers to “the word” or “God’s message.” | |
268 | MRK | 4 | 16 | ty3q | figs-metaphor | οὗτοί εἰσιν…οἱ | 1 | These are the ones | “In some people the word is like the seeds.” Jesus begins to explain how in some people, the word acts like the seeds that fell on the rocky soil. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
269 | MRK | 4 | 17 | p5fr | figs-metaphor | οὐκ ἔχουσιν ῥίζαν ἐν ἑαυτοῖς | 1 | They have no root in themselves | This is a comparison to the young plants that have very shallow roots. This metaphor means that the people were first excited when they received the word, but they were not strongly devoted to it. Alternate translation: “And the roots of the young plants are not able to penetrate into them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
270 | MRK | 4 | 17 | s5mh | figs-hyperbole | οὐκ…ῥίζαν | 1 | no root | This is an exaggeration to emphasize how shallow the roots were. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
271 | MRK | 4 | 17 | l8xa | figs-explicit | γενομένης θλίψεως ἢ διωγμοῦ διὰ τὸν λόγον | 1 | tribulation or persecution having come because of the word | It may be helpful to explain that **tribulation** comes because people believed God’s message. Alternate translation: “when tribulation or persecution comes because they believed God’s message” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
272 | MRK | 4 | 17 | t21w | figs-metaphor | σκανδαλίζονται | 1 | they are caused to stumble | In this parable, **to stumble** means “to stop believing God’s message” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
273 | MRK | 4 | 18 | uu9b | figs-metaphor | ἄλλοι εἰσὶν οἱ εἰς τὰς ἀκάνθας σπειρόμενοι | 1 | others are the ones sown among the thorns | Jesus begins to explain how the effect of the word on some people is like the seeds that fell among the thorns. Alternate translation: “the response of other people is like the seeds that were sown among the thorns” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
274 | MRK | 4 | 19 | wa3k | αἱ μέριμναι τοῦ αἰῶνος | 1 | the cares of this age | “the worries in this life” or “the concerns about this present life” | |
275 | MRK | 4 | 19 | jm32 | ἡ ἀπάτη τοῦ πλούτου | 1 | the deceitfulness of riches | “the desires for riches” | |
276 | MRK | 4 | 19 | s7s7 | figs-metaphor | εἰσπορευόμεναι, συνπνίγουσιν τὸν λόγον | 1 | entering in choke the word | As Jesus continues to talk about people in whom the word is like the seeds that fell among the thorns, he explains what the desires and worries do to the word in their lives. Alternate translation: “enter in and choke God’s message in their lives like thorns choke young plants” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
277 | MRK | 4 | 19 | f4ip | ἄκαρπος γίνεται | 1 | it becomes unfruitful | “the word does not produce a crop in them” | |
278 | MRK | 4 | 20 | axh1 | figs-metaphor | ἐκεῖνοί εἰσιν οἱ ἐπὶ τὴν γῆν τὴν καλὴν σπαρέντες | 1 | these are the ones sown in the good soil | Jesus begins to explain how in some people the word is like seeds that were sown in good soil. Alternate translation: “these are the ones in whom the word is like the seeds that were sown in the good soil” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
279 | MRK | 4 | 20 | d3r7 | figs-ellipsis | ἓν τριάκοντα, καὶ ἓν ἑξήκοντα, καὶ ἓν ἑκατόν | 1 | one, 30, and one, 60, and one, 100 | This refers to the grain that the plants produce. Alternate translation: “some produce 30 grains, some produce 60 grains, and some produce 100 grains” or “some produce 30 times the grain that was sown, some produce 60 times the grain that was sown, and some produce 100 times the grain that was sown” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
280 | MRK | 4 | 20 | tdwj | translate-numbers | τριάκοντα…ἑξήκοντα…ἑκατόν | 1 | 30 … 60 … 100 | The numbers can be stated as text. Alternate translation: “thirty … sixty … a hundred” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
281 | MRK | 4 | 21 | zzw7 | καὶ ἔλεγεν αὐτοῖς | 1 | And he was saying to them | “And Jesus said to the crowd” | |
282 | MRK | 4 | 21 | nn7e | figs-rquestion | μήτι ἔρχεται ὁ λύχνος ἵνα ὑπὸ τὸν μόδιον τεθῇ, ἢ ὑπὸ τὴν κλίνην? | 1 | The lamp does not come in order to be put under a basket, or under the bed, does it? | This question may be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “You certainly do not bring a lamp inside the house to put it under a basket, or under a bed!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
283 | MRK | 4 | 22 | y5kn | figs-litotes | οὐ γάρ ἐστιν κρυπτὸν, ἐὰν μὴ ἵνα φανερωθῇ; οὐδὲ ἐγένετο ἀπόκρυφον, ἀλλ’ ἵνα ἔλθῃ εἰς φανερόν | 1 | For nothing is hidden except so that it might be revealed, and nothing secret has happened except so that it might come to exposure | This can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “For everything that is hidden will be made known, and everything that is secret will come out into to open” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]]) |
284 | MRK | 4 | 22 | kc6k | figs-parallelism | οὐ…ἐστιν κρυπτὸν…οὐδὲ ἐγένετο ἀπόκρυφον | 1 | nothing is hidden … and nothing secret has happened | “there is nothing that is hidden … there is nothing that is secret” Both of the phrases have the same meaning. Jesus is emphasizing that everything that is secret will be made known. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]]) |
285 | MRK | 4 | 23 | k1a8 | figs-metonymy | εἴ τις ἔχει ὦτα ἀκούειν, ἀκουέτω | 1 | If anyone has ears to hear, let him hear | Jesus is emphasizing that what he has just said is important and may take some effort to understand and put into practice. The phrase **ears to hear** here is a metonym for the willingness to understand and obey. See how you translated a similar phrase in [Mark 4:9](../04/09.md). Alternate translation: “If anyone is willing to listen, listen” or “If anyone is willing to understand, let him understand and obey” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
286 | MRK | 4 | 23 | izg1 | figs-123person | εἴ τις ἔχει ὦτα ἀκούειν, ἀκουέτω | 1 | If anyone has ears to hear, let him hear | Since Jesus is speaking directly to his audience, you may prefer to use the second person here. See how you translated a similar phrase in [Mark 4:9](../04/09.md). Alternate translation: “If you are willing to listen, listen” or “If you are willing to understand, then understand and obey” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]]) |
287 | MRK | 4 | 24 | r2r1 | ἔλεγεν αὐτοῖς | 1 | he was saying to them | “Jesus said to the crowd” | |
288 | MRK | 4 | 24 | zis1 | figs-metaphor | ἐν ᾧ μέτρῳ μετρεῖτε | 1 | In that measure you use | This could mean: (1) Jesus is talking about a literal **measure** and giving generously to others or (2) this is a metaphor in which Jesus speaks of “understanding” as if it were “measuring.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
289 | MRK | 4 | 24 | c4xp | figs-activepassive | μετρηθήσεται ὑμῖν, καὶ προστεθήσεται ὑμῖν | 1 | it will be measured to you, and it will be added to you | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will measure that amount for you, and he will add it to you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
290 | MRK | 4 | 25 | i24l | figs-activepassive | δοθήσεται αὐτῷ…καὶ ὃ ἔχει ἀρθήσεται ἀπ’ αὐτο | 1 | to him will be given … even what he has will be taken away from him | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “to him God will give more … from him God will take away” or “God will give more to him … God will take away from him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
291 | MRK | 4 | 26 | n1mq | figs-parables | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus then tells the people parables to explain the kingdom of God, which he later explains to his disciples. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]]) | |
292 | MRK | 4 | 26 | r5n7 | figs-simile | ὡς ἄνθρωπος βάλῃ τὸν σπόρον | 1 | As a man who may throw his seed | Jesus likens the kingdom of God to a farmer **who may throw his seed**. Alternate translation: “like a farmer who sows his seed” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]]) |
293 | MRK | 4 | 27 | y5m5 | καθεύδῃ καὶ ἐγείρηται, νύκτα καὶ ἡμέραν | 1 | he may sleep and may be awakened, night and day | This is something that the man habitually does. Alternate translation: “he sleeps each night and gets up each day” or “he sleeps each night and gets up the next day” | |
294 | MRK | 4 | 27 | c6jv | ὡς οὐκ οἶδεν αὐτός | 1 | how, he himself does not know | “though the man does not know how the seed sprouts and grows” | |
295 | MRK | 4 | 28 | diz5 | χόρτον | 1 | the blade | the stalk or sprout | |
296 | MRK | 4 | 28 | cew8 | στάχυν | 1 | the ear | the head on the stalk or the part of the plant that holds the fruit | |
297 | MRK | 4 | 29 | ah9d | figs-metonymy | εὐθὺς ἀποστέλλει τὸ δρέπανον | 1 | he immediately sends forth the sickle | Here, **the sickle** is a metonym that stands for the farmer or the people whom the farmer sends out to harvest the grain. Alternate translation: “he immediately goes into the field with a sickle to harvest the grain” or “he immediately sends people with sickles into the field to harvest the grain” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
298 | MRK | 4 | 29 | yd1d | δρέπανον | 1 | sickle | a curved blade or a sharp hook used to cut grain | |
299 | MRK | 4 | 29 | hx6v | figs-idiom | ὅτι παρέστηκεν ὁ θερισμός | 1 | because the harvest has come | Here the phrase **has come** is an idiom for the grain being ripe for harvest. Alternate translation: “because the grain is ready to be harvested” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
300 | MRK | 4 | 30 | ivk2 | figs-rquestion | πῶς ὁμοιώσωμεν τὴν Βασιλείαν τοῦ Θεοῦ, ἢ ἐν τίνι αὐτὴν παραβολῇ θῶμεν? | 1 | How might we compare the kingdom of God, or in what parable might we present it? | Jesus asked this question to cause his hearers to think about what **the kingdom of God** is. Alternate translation: “With this parable I can explain what the kingdom of God is like.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
301 | MRK | 4 | 31 | w4l5 | ὅταν σπαρῇ | 1 | when it may have been sown | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “when someone sows it” or “when someone plants it” | |
302 | MRK | 4 | 32 | x1xh | figs-personification | καὶ ποιεῖ κλάδους μεγάλους | 1 | and it forms large branches | The mustard tree is described as causing its branches to grow large. Alternate translation: “with large branches” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]]) |
303 | MRK | 4 | 33 | v2rp | figs-synecdoche | ἐλάλει αὐτοῖς τὸν λόγον | 1 | he was speaking the word to them | Here, **word** is a synecdoche for “message of God.” The word **them** refers to the crowds. Alternate translation: “he taught the message of God to them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
304 | MRK | 4 | 33 | vhe5 | καθὼς ἠδύναντο ἀκούειν | 1 | just as they were able to hear | “and if they were able to understand some, he kept telling them more” | |
305 | MRK | 4 | 34 | q2ht | κατ’ ἰδίαν | 1 | by himself | This means that he was away from the crowds, but his disciples were still with him. | |
306 | MRK | 4 | 34 | gp99 | figs-hyperbole | ἐπέλυεν πάντα | 1 | he was explaining everything | Here, **everything** is an exaggeration. He explained all his parables. Alternate translation: “he explained all his parables” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
307 | MRK | 4 | 35 | qua2 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | As Jesus and his disciples take a boat to escape the crowds of people, a great storm arises. His disciples are afraid when they see that even the wind and the sea obey Jesus. | ||
308 | MRK | 4 | 35 | hc5b | λέγει αὐτοῖς | 1 | he says to them | “Jesus said to his disciples” | |
309 | MRK | 4 | 35 | biy2 | τὸ πέραν | 1 | the other side | “the other side of the Sea of Galilee” or “the other side of the sea” | |
310 | MRK | 4 | 37 | at6u | figs-ellipsis | ἤδη γεμίζεσθαι τὸ πλοῖον | 1 | to already be filling the boat | It may be helpful to state that **the boat** was **filling** up with water. Alternate translation: “the boat was in danger of being filled with water” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
311 | MRK | 4 | 38 | qy5l | τῇ πρύμνῃ | 1 | the stern | This is at the very back of the boat. “the stern of the boat” | |
312 | MRK | 4 | 38 | xdm6 | ἐγείρουσιν αὐτὸν | 1 | they wake him up | The word **they** refers to the disciples. | |
313 | MRK | 4 | 38 | b4xb | figs-rquestion | οὐ μέλει σοι ὅτι ἀπολλύμεθα? | 1 | do you not care that we are perishing? | The disciples asked this question to convey their fear. This question can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “you need to pay attention to what is happening; we are all about to die!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
314 | MRK | 4 | 38 | qtb3 | figs-exclusive | ἀπολλύμεθα | 1 | we are perishing | The word **we** includes the disciples and Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]]) |
315 | MRK | 4 | 39 | yym6 | figs-doublet | σιώπα, πεφίμωσο | 1 | Be silent! Be still! | These two phrases are similar and used to emphasize what Jesus wanted the wind and the sea to do. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]]) |
316 | MRK | 4 | 39 | ag41 | γαλήνη μεγάλη | 1 | a great calm | “a great stillness over the sea” or “a great calm over the sea” | |
317 | MRK | 4 | 40 | h7n3 | καὶ εἶπεν αὐτοῖς | 1 | And he said to them | “And Jesus said to his disciples” | |
318 | MRK | 4 | 40 | w5n4 | figs-rquestion | τί δειλοί ἐστε? οὔπω ἔχετε πίστιν | 1 | Why are you afraid? Do you not yet have faith? | Jesus asks these questions to make his disciples consider why they are **afraid** when he is with them. These questions can be written as statements. Alternate translation: “You should not be afraid. You need to have more faith.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
319 | MRK | 4 | 41 | u8e1 | figs-rquestion | τίς ἄρα οὗτός ἐστιν, ὅτι καὶ ὁ ἄνεμος καὶ ἡ θάλασσα ὑπακούει αὐτῷ? | 1 | Who then is this, for even the wind and the sea obey him? | The disciples ask this question in amazement at what Jesus did. This question can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “This man is not like ordinary men; even the wind and the sea obey him!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
320 | MRK | 5 | intro | lh25 | 0 | # Mark 05 General Notes<br><br>## Possible translation difficulties in this chapter<br><br>### “Talitha, koum”<br><br>The words **Talitha, koum** ([Mark 5:41](../../mrk/05/41.md)) are from the Aramaic language. Mark writes them the way they sound and then translates them. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]]) | |||
321 | MRK | 5 | 1 | fix1 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After Jesus calms the great storm, he heals a man who has many demons, but the local people in Gerasa are not glad about his healing, and they beg Jesus to leave. | ||
322 | MRK | 5 | 1 | gt8a | ἦλθον | 1 | They came | The word **They** refers to Jesus and his disciples. | |
323 | MRK | 5 | 1 | ahx8 | τῆς θαλάσσης | 1 | the sea | This refers to the Sea of Galilee. | |
324 | MRK | 5 | 1 | vsc7 | translate-names | τῶν Γερασηνῶν | 1 | the Gerasenes | This name refers to the people who live in Gerasa. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
325 | MRK | 5 | 2 | pf16 | figs-idiom | ἐν πνεύματι ἀκαθάρτῳ | 1 | with an unclean spirit | This is an idiom meaning that the man is “controlled” or “possessed” by the unclean spirit. Alternate translation: “controlled by an unclean spirit” or “that an unclean spirit possessed” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
326 | MRK | 5 | 4 | da4x | figs-activepassive | αὐτὸν πολλάκις…δεδέσθαι | 1 | He had been bound many times | This can be written in active form. Alternate translation: “People had bound him many times” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
327 | MRK | 5 | 4 | nep6 | figs-activepassive | τὰς πέδας συντετρῖφθαι | 1 | his shackles were shattered | This can be written in active form. Alternate translation: “he shattered his shackles” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
328 | MRK | 5 | 4 | fk7t | πέδαις | 1 | shackles | pieces of metal that people wrap around the arms and legs of prisoners and attach with chains to objects that do not move so the prisoners cannot move | |
329 | MRK | 5 | 4 | tu2d | figs-explicit | οὐδεὶς ἴσχυεν αὐτὸν δαμάσαι | 1 | no one was strong enough to subdue him | The man was so **strong** that **no one** could **subdue him**. Alternate translation: “He was so strong that no one was strong enough to subdue him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
330 | MRK | 5 | 4 | gp74 | αὐτὸν δαμάσαι | 1 | to subdue him | “to control him” | |
331 | MRK | 5 | 5 | z9ah | κατακόπτων ἑαυτὸν λίθοις | 1 | cut himself with stones | Often times when a person is possessed by a demon, the demon will cause the person to do self-destructive things, such as cutting himself. | |
332 | MRK | 5 | 6 | y6c2 | figs-explicit | καὶ ἰδὼν τὸν Ἰησοῦν ἀπὸ μακρόθεν | 1 | And seeing Jesus from a distance | When the man first saw Jesus, Jesus would have been getting out of the boat. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
333 | MRK | 5 | 6 | pw4y | προσεκύνησεν | 1 | bowed down before | This means that he knelt down before Jesus out of reverence and respect, not out of worship. | |
334 | MRK | 5 | 7 | ux6u | figs-events | 0 | General Information: | The information in these two verses may be reordered to present the events in the order that they happened, as in the UST. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-events]]) | |
335 | MRK | 5 | 7 | tt7a | κράξας | 1 | crying out | “the unclean spirit, crying out” | |
336 | MRK | 5 | 7 | ppu5 | figs-rquestion | τί ἐμοὶ καὶ σοί Ἰησοῦ, Υἱὲ τοῦ Θεοῦ τοῦ Ὑψίστου? | 1 | What to me and to you, Jesus, Son of the Most High God? | The unclean spirit asks this question out of fear. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “Leave me alone, Jesus, Son of the Most High God! There is no reason for you to interfere with me.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
337 | MRK | 5 | 7 | q8c8 | Ἰησοῦ…μή με βασανίσῃς | 1 | Jesus … may you not torment me | Jesus has the power to torment unclean spirits. | |
338 | MRK | 5 | 7 | kd19 | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | Υἱὲ τοῦ Θεοῦ τοῦ Ὑψίστου | 1 | Son of the Most High God | This is an important title for Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
339 | MRK | 5 | 7 | p768 | ὁρκίζω σε τὸν Θεόν | 1 | I beg you by God | Here the unclean spirit is swearing **by God** as he makes a request of Jesus. Consider how this type of request is made in your language. Alternate translation: “I beg you before God” or “I swear by God himself and beg you” | |
340 | MRK | 5 | 9 | p6ye | ἐπηρώτα αὐτόν | 1 | he was asking him | “Jesus asked the unclean spirit” | |
341 | MRK | 5 | 9 | h6ch | figs-metaphor | λέγει αὐτῷ, Λεγιὼν ὄνομά μοι, ὅτι πολλοί ἐσμεν. | 1 | he says to him, “My name is Legion, for we are many.” | One spirit was speaking for many here. He spoke of them as if they were a legion, a Roman army unit of about 6,000 soldiers. Alternate translation: “And the spirit said to him, ‘Call us an army, for many of us are inside the man.’” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
342 | MRK | 5 | 12 | uk54 | παρεκάλεσαν αὐτὸν | 1 | they begged him | “the unclean spirits begged Jesus” | |
343 | MRK | 5 | 13 | iff6 | figs-explicit | ἐπέτρεψεν αὐτοῖς | 1 | he permitted them | It may be helpful to state clearly what Jesus allowed them to do. Alternate translation: “Jesus allowed the unclean spirits to do what they asked permission to do” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
344 | MRK | 5 | 13 | g3xx | ὥρμησεν…κατὰ τοῦ κρημνοῦ εἰς τὴν θάλασσαν, ὡς δισχίλιοι, καὶ ἐπνίγοντο ἐν τῇ θαλάσσῃ | 1 | about 2,000—rushed down the steep hill into the sea, and drowned in the sea | You can make this a separate sentence: “rushed down the steep slope into the sea. There were about 2,000 pigs, and they drowned in the sea” | |
345 | MRK | 5 | 13 | a28z | translate-numbers | ὡς δισχίλιοι | 1 | about 2,000 | “about two thousand pigs” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
346 | MRK | 5 | 14 | lt8x | figs-ellipsis | εἰς τὴν πόλιν καὶ εἰς τοὺς ἀγρούς | 1 | in the city and in the countryside | It can be stated clearly that the men gave their report to the people who were in the **city** and **countryside**. Alternate translation: “to people in the city and in the countryside” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
347 | MRK | 5 | 15 | qih4 | τὸν λεγεῶνα | 1 | the Legion | This was the name of the many demons that were in the man. See how you translated this in [Mark 5:9](../05/09.md). | |
348 | MRK | 5 | 15 | fb4b | figs-idiom | σωφρονοῦντα | 1 | being in his right mind | This is an idiom meaning that he is thinking clearly. Alternate translation: “being of a normal mind” or “thinking clearly” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
349 | MRK | 5 | 15 | yv69 | ἐφοβήθησαν | 1 | they became afraid | The word **they** refers to the group of people who went out to see what had happened. | |
350 | MRK | 5 | 16 | t4ez | οἱ ἰδόντες, πῶς ἐγένετο | 1 | those who had seen how it happened | “the people who had witnessed what had happened” | |
351 | MRK | 5 | 18 | mwg9 | ὁ δαιμονισθεὶς | 1 | the one who had been demon-possessed | Though the man is no longer **demon-possessed**, he is still described in this way. Alternate translation: “the man who had been demon-possessed” | |
352 | MRK | 5 | 19 | e21m | figs-explicit | καὶ οὐκ ἀφῆκεν αὐτόν | 1 | But he did not permit him | What Jesus did not allow the man to do can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “But he did not allow the man to come with them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
353 | MRK | 5 | 20 | g8ed | translate-names | τῇ Δεκαπόλει | 1 | the Decapolis | This is the name of a region that means “Ten Cities.” It is located to the southeast of the Sea of Galilee. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
354 | MRK | 5 | 20 | y8vn | figs-ellipsis | πάντες ἐθαύμαζον | 1 | everyone was marvelling | It may be helpful to state why the people were **marvelling**. Alternate translation: “all the people who heard what the man said were amazed” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
355 | MRK | 5 | 21 | wyl3 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After healing the demon-possessed man in region of the Gerasenes, Jesus and his disciples return across the lake to Capernaum where the one of the rulers of the synagogue asks Jesus to heal his daughter. | ||
356 | MRK | 5 | 21 | t3dc | figs-ellipsis | τὸ πέραν | 1 | the other side | It may be helpful to add information to this phrase. Alternate translation: “the other side of the sea” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
357 | MRK | 5 | 21 | lyt8 | παρὰ τὴν θάλασσαν | 1 | beside the sea | “on the seashore” or “on the shore” | |
358 | MRK | 5 | 21 | p4p7 | τὴν θάλασσαν | 1 | the sea | This is the Sea of Galilee. | |
359 | MRK | 5 | 22 | v1dm | translate-names | Ἰάειρος | 1 | Jairus | This is the name of a man. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
360 | MRK | 5 | 23 | jd27 | ἐπιθῇς τὰς χεῖρας | 1 | you may lay your hands | Here, **lay your hands** refers to a prophet or teacher placing his hand on someone and imparting either healing or a blessing. In this case, Jarius is asking Jesus to heal his daughter. | |
361 | MRK | 5 | 23 | kzz8 | figs-activepassive | ἵνα σωθῇ καὶ ζήσῃ | 1 | in order that she may be healed and she may live | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “and heal her and make her live” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
362 | MRK | 5 | 24 | d7zg | figs-explicit | καὶ ἀπῆλθεν μετ’ αὐτοῦ | 1 | And went with him | “So Jesus went with Jairus.” Jesus’ disciples also went with him. Alternate translation: “So Jesus and the disciples went with Jairus” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
363 | MRK | 5 | 24 | jgg5 | συνέθλιβον αὐτόν | 1 | was pressing around him | This means they crowded around Jesus and pressed themselves together to be closer to Jesus. | |
364 | MRK | 5 | 25 | rn7h | 0 | Connecting Statement: | While Jesus is on his way to heal the man’s little 12-year-old girl, a woman who has been sick for 12 years interrupts by touching Jesus for her healing. | ||
365 | MRK | 5 | 25 | e2cz | writing-participants | καὶ γυνὴ οὖσα | 1 | And a woman, being | This introduces the woman as a new character in the story. Consider how new people are introduced into a story in your language. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-participants]]) |
366 | MRK | 5 | 25 | h58w | figs-euphemism | ἐν ῥύσει αἵματος δώδεκα ἔτη | 1 | with a flow of blood for 12 years | The woman did not have an open wound; rather, her monthly flow of blood would not stop. Your language may have a polite way to refer to this condition. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]]) |
367 | MRK | 5 | 25 | idh9 | translate-numbers | δώδεκα ἔτη | 1 | for 12 years | “for twelve years” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
368 | MRK | 5 | 26 | vgh2 | εἰς τὸ χεῖρον ἐλθοῦσα | 1 | having become worse | “her sickness got worse” or “her bleeding increased” | |
369 | MRK | 5 | 27 | z2hg | figs-explicit | τὰ περὶ τοῦ Ἰησοῦ | 1 | the things about Jesus | She had heard reports about Jesus of how he healed people. Alternate translation: “that Jesus healed people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
370 | MRK | 5 | 27 | v7h8 | τοῦ ἱματίου | 1 | cloak | outer garment or coat | |
371 | MRK | 5 | 28 | wge2 | figs-activepassive | σωθήσομαι | 1 | I will be saved | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “it will save me” or “his power will heal me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
372 | MRK | 5 | 29 | c1vz | figs-activepassive | ἴαται ἀπὸ τῆς μάστιγος | 1 | she had been healed from the disease | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the sickness had left her” or “she was no longer sick” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
373 | MRK | 5 | 30 | ma2b | τὴν ἐξ αὐτοῦ δύναμιν ἐξελθοῦσαν | 1 | his power had gone out from him | When the woman touched Jesus, Jesus felt **his power** healing her. Jesus himself did not lose any of his power to heal people when he healed her. Alternate translation: “his healing power had healed the woman” | |
374 | MRK | 5 | 31 | hb58 | τὸν ὄχλον συνθλίβοντά σε | 1 | this crowd pressed in on you | This means they crowded around Jesus and **pressed** themselves together to be closer to Jesus. See how you translated this in [Mark 5:24](../05/24.md). | |
375 | MRK | 5 | 33 | yn9g | προσέπεσεν αὐτῷ | 1 | fell down before him | “knelt down before him.” She knelt down before Jesus as an act of honor and submission. | |
376 | MRK | 5 | 33 | b6kz | figs-ellipsis | εἶπεν αὐτῷ πᾶσαν τὴν ἀλήθειαν | 1 | told him the whole truth | The phrase **the whole truth** refers to how she had touched him and became well. Alternate translation: “told him the whole truth about how she had touched him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
377 | MRK | 5 | 34 | gbk8 | θυγάτηρ | 1 | Daughter | Jesus was using this term figuratively to refer to the woman as a believer. | |
378 | MRK | 5 | 34 | a5qw | ἡ πίστις σου | 1 | your faith | “your faith in me” | |
379 | MRK | 5 | 35 | kmm7 | ἔτι αὐτοῦ λαλοῦντος | 1 | While he was still speaking | “While Jesus was still speaking” | |
380 | MRK | 5 | 35 | ld5e | ἔρχονται ἀπὸ τοῦ ἀρχισυναγώγου | 1 | they came from the synagogue leader’s house | This could mean: (1) these people had come from Jarius’ house or (2) Jairus had previously given these people orders to go see Jesus or (3) these people had been sent by the man who was presiding as the synagogue leader in Jairus’ absence. | |
381 | MRK | 5 | 35 | akl8 | τοῦ ἀρχισυναγώγου | 1 | the synagogue leader’s house | The leader of the synagogue is Jairus. | |
382 | MRK | 5 | 35 | ip1p | λέγοντες | 1 | saying | “saying to Jairus” | |
383 | MRK | 5 | 35 | t2wd | figs-rquestion | τί ἔτι σκύλλεις τὸν διδάσκαλον? | 1 | Why trouble the teacher any longer? | This question can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “It is useless to bother the teacher any longer.” or “There no need to bother the teacher any longer.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
384 | MRK | 5 | 35 | c5c1 | τὸν διδάσκαλον | 1 | the teacher | This refers to Jesus. | |
385 | MRK | 5 | 36 | zei3 | translate-versebridge | 0 | General Information: | You may want to combine verses 37 and 38 and reorder them to present the events in the order that they happened, as in the UST. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-versebridge]]) | |
386 | MRK | 5 | 36 | ge2r | μόνον πίστευε | 1 | Only believe | If necessary, you can state what Jesus is commanding Jairus to believe. Alternate translation: “Just believe I can make you daughter live” | |
387 | MRK | 5 | 37 | y884 | οὐκ ἀφῆκεν | 1 | he did not permit | Jesus did not permit | |
388 | MRK | 5 | 37 | ed49 | figs-explicit | μετ’ αὐτοῦ συνακολουθῆσαι | 1 | to accompany him | “to come with him.” It may be helpful to state where they were going. Alternate translation: “to accompany him to Jairus’ house” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
389 | MRK | 5 | 38 | t154 | θεωρεῖ | 1 | sees | Jesus saw | |
390 | MRK | 5 | 39 | m7pu | λέγει αὐτοῖς | 1 | he says to them | “Jesus said to the people who were weeping” | |
391 | MRK | 5 | 39 | a3ih | figs-rquestion | τί θορυβεῖσθε καὶ κλαίετε? | 1 | Why are you upset and weeping? | Jesus asked this question to help them see their lack of faith. This may be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “This is not a time to be upset and crying.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
392 | MRK | 5 | 39 | g83c | τὸ παιδίον οὐκ ἀπέθανεν, ἀλλὰ καθεύδει | 1 | The child has not died, but is sleeping | Jesus uses the common word for sleep, and so should the translation. | |
393 | MRK | 5 | 40 | jm38 | κατεγέλων αὐτοῦ | 1 | They were laughing at him | Jesus used the common word for sleep (verse 39). The reader should understand that the people who hear Jesus laugh at him because they truly do know the difference between a dead person and a sleeping person and they think he does not. | |
394 | MRK | 5 | 40 | tkl7 | ἐκβαλὼν πάντας | 1 | having put them all outside | “having sent all the other people outside the house” | |
395 | MRK | 5 | 40 | mi3u | τοὺς μετ’ αὐτοῦ | 1 | those with him | This refers to Peter, James, and John. | |
396 | MRK | 5 | 40 | wca3 | figs-explicit | εἰσπορεύεται ὅπου ἦν τὸ παιδίον | 1 | he enters where the child was | It may be helpful to state where **the child** is. Alternate translation: “he went into the room where the child was lying” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
397 | MRK | 5 | 41 | hx3c | translate-transliterate | ταλιθὰ, κοῦμ! | 1 | Talitha, koum! | This is an Aramaic sentence, which Jesus spoke to the little girl in her language. Write these words as is with your alphabet. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]]) |
398 | MRK | 5 | 42 | pt5t | translate-numbers | ἦν…ἐτῶν δώδεκα | 1 | she was 12 years of age | “she was twelve years old” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
399 | MRK | 5 | 43 | i5ja | figs-quotations | διεστείλατο αὐτοῖς πολλὰ ἵνα μηδεὶς γνοῖ τοῦτο, καὶ | 1 | he strictly ordered them that no one should know about this, and | This can be stated as a direct quote. Alternate translation: “he ordered them strictly, ‘No one should know about this!’ Then” or “he ordered them strictly, ‘Do not tell anyone about what I have done!’ Then” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]]) |
400 | MRK | 5 | 43 | ij1k | διεστείλατο αὐτοῖς πολλὰ | 1 | he strictly ordered them | “he strongly commanded them” | |
401 | MRK | 5 | 43 | n29k | figs-quotations | καὶ εἶπεν δοθῆναι αὐτῇ φαγεῖν | 1 | and he told them to give her something to eat | This can be stated as a direct quote. Alternate translation: “and he told them, ‘Give her something to eat.’” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]]) |
402 | MRK | 6 | intro | kl7n | 0 | # Mark 06 General Notes<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### “Anointed with oil”<br><br>In the ancient Near East, people would try to heal sick people by putting olive oil on them. | |||
403 | MRK | 6 | 1 | mi7z | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus returns to his hometown, where he is not accepted. | ||
404 | MRK | 6 | 1 | mjr1 | τὴν πατρίδα αὐτοῦ | 1 | his hometown | This refers to the town of Nazareth, where Jesus grew up and where his family lived. This does not mean that he owned land there. | |
405 | MRK | 6 | 2 | y4xj | τίς ἡ σοφία ἡ δοθεῖσα τούτῳ | 1 | what is this wisdom that has been given to him? | This question, which contains passive construction, can be asked in active form. Alternate translation: “what is this wisdom that he has gained?” | |
406 | MRK | 6 | 2 | s1xy | διὰ τῶν χειρῶν αὐτοῦ γινόμεναι | 1 | being done by his hands | This phrase emphasizes that Jesus himself does the miracles. Alternate translation: “that he himself works” | |
407 | MRK | 6 | 3 | s3wl | figs-rquestion | οὐχ οὗτός ἐστιν ὁ τέκτων, ὁ υἱὸς τῆς Μαρίας, καὶ ἀδελφὸς Ἰακώβου, καὶ Ἰωσῆτος, καὶ Ἰούδα, καὶ Σίμωνος? καὶ οὐκ εἰσὶν αἱ ἀδελφαὶ αὐτοῦ ὧδε πρὸς ἡμᾶς? | 1 | Is this not the carpenter, the son of Mary and the brother of James and Joses and Judas and Simon? And are his sisters not here with us? | These questions can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “He is just an ordinary carpenter! We know him and his family. We know Mary his mother. We know his younger brothers James, Joses, Judas and Simon. And his younger sisters also live here with us.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
408 | MRK | 6 | 3 | tlub | translate-names | Ἰακώβου…Ἰωσῆτος…Ἰούδα…Σίμωνος | 1 | James … Joses … Judas … Simon | These are the names of men. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
409 | MRK | 6 | 4 | ni6w | αὐτοῖς | 1 | to them | “to the crowd” | |
410 | MRK | 6 | 4 | l436 | figs-doublenegatives | οὐκ ἔστιν προφήτης ἄτιμος, εἰ μὴ | 1 | A prophet is not without honor, except | This sentence uses a double negative to create emphasis of the positive equivalent. Alternate translation: “A prophet is always honored, except” or “The only place a prophet is not honored is” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]]) |
411 | MRK | 6 | 5 | k9gh | ὀλίγοις ἀρρώστοις, ἐπιθεὶς τὰς χεῖρας | 1 | having laid his hands on a few sick people, he healed them. | Prophets and teachers would put their **hands** on people in order to heal them or bless them. In this case, Jesus was healing people. | |
412 | MRK | 6 | 7 | w7qq | translate-versebridge | 0 | General Information: | Jesus’ instructions in verses 8 and 9 can be reordered to separate what he told the disciples to do from what he told them not to do, as in the UST. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-versebridge]]) | |
413 | MRK | 6 | 7 | g5um | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus sends his disciples out in sets of two to preach and to heal. | ||
414 | MRK | 6 | 7 | pmq4 | προσκαλεῖται τοὺς δώδεκα | 1 | he called the Twelve | Here the word **called** means that he summoned the Twelve to come to him. | |
415 | MRK | 6 | 7 | d6sx | translate-numbers | δύο δύο | 1 | two by two | “2 by 2” or “in pairs” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
416 | MRK | 6 | 8 | t9a2 | figs-synecdoche | μὴ ἄρτον | 1 | no bread | Here, **bread** is a synecdoche for food in general. Alternate translation: “no food” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
417 | MRK | 6 | 10 | wv9h | ἔλεγεν αὐτοῖς | 1 | he was saying to them | “Jesus said to the Twelve” | |
418 | MRK | 6 | 10 | h31d | figs-metonymy | ἐκεῖ μένετε ἕως ἂν ἐξέλθητε ἐκεῖθεν | 1 | remain there until you may go away from there | Here, **remain** represents daily going back to that house to eat and sleep there. Alternate translation: “eat and sleep in that house until you leave that place” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
419 | MRK | 6 | 11 | b2kb | figs-explicit | εἰς μαρτύριον αὐτοῖς | 1 | as a testimony against them | It may be helpful to explain how this action was **a testimony against them**. Alternate translation: “as a testimony to them. By doing that, you will be testifying that they did not welcome you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
420 | MRK | 6 | 12 | sqt2 | figs-ellipsis | ἐξελθόντες | 1 | having gone out | It may be helpful to state that they went out to various towns. Alternate translation: “having gone out to various towns” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
421 | MRK | 6 | 12 | xtva | ἐκήρυξαν | 1 | they proclaimed | The word **they** refers to the Twelve and does not include Jesus. | |
422 | MRK | 6 | 13 | i7eq | figs-ellipsis | δαιμόνια πολλὰ ἐξέβαλλον | 1 | they were casting out many demons | It may be helpful to state that they cast the demons out of people. Alternate translation: “they were casting many demons out of people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
423 | MRK | 6 | 14 | y69r | 0 | Connecting Statement: | When Herod hears about Jesus’ miracles, he worries, thinking that someone has raised John the Baptist from the dead. (Herod had caused John the Baptist to be killed.) | ||
424 | MRK | 6 | 14 | f9um | ἤκουσεν ὁ βασιλεὺς Ἡρῴδης | 1 | King Herod heard this | The word **this** refers to everything that Jesus and his disciples had been doing in various towns, including casting out demons and healing people. | |
425 | MRK | 6 | 14 | sc6s | figs-explicit | ἔλεγον, ὅτι Ἰωάννης ὁ βαπτίζων ἐγήγερται | 1 | some were saying, “John the Baptist has been raised | Some people were saying that Jesus was **John the Baptist**. This can be stated more clearly. Alternate translation: “Some were saying, ‘He is John the Baptist who has been raised” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
426 | MRK | 6 | 14 | cb7p | figs-idiom | Ἰωάννης ὁ βαπτίζων ἐγήγερται | 1 | John the Baptist has been raised | Here, **raised** is an idiom for “caused to live again.” Alternate translation: “John the Baptist has been caused to live again” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
427 | MRK | 6 | 14 | ly7z | figs-activepassive | Ἰωάννης ὁ βαπτίζων ἐγήγερται | 1 | John the Baptist has been raised | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God has caused John the Baptist to live again” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
428 | MRK | 6 | 15 | fgy3 | figs-explicit | ἄλλοι δὲ ἔλεγον, ὅτι Ἠλείας ἐστίν | 1 | But others were saying, “He is Elijah.” | It may be helpful to state why some people thought he was **Elijah**. Alternate translation: “Some others said, ‘He is Elijah, whom God promised to send back again.’” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
429 | MRK | 6 | 16 | bg3k | writing-background | 0 | General Information: | In verse 17 the author begins to give background information about Herod and why he beheaded John the Baptist. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) | |
430 | MRK | 6 | 16 | ym2w | figs-metonymy | ὃν ἐγὼ ἀπεκεφάλισα | 1 | whom I beheaded | Here Herod uses the word **I** to refer to himself. The word **I** is a metonym for Herod’s soldiers. Alternate translation: “whom I commanded my soldiers to behead” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
431 | MRK | 6 | 16 | n6nq | figs-activepassive | ἠγέρθη | 1 | has been raised | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “has become alive again” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
432 | MRK | 6 | 17 | vpr7 | figs-explicit | αὐτὸς…ὁ Ἡρῴδης, ἀποστείλας ἐκράτησεν τὸν Ἰωάννην, καὶ ἔδησεν αὐτὸν ἐν φυλακῇ | 1 | Herod himself, having sent, seized John and he bound him in prison | It can be stated clearly that **Herod** sent his soldiers to put **John** in **prison**. Alternate translation: “Herod sent his soldiers to arrest John and had them bind him in prison” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
433 | MRK | 6 | 17 | a5du | διὰ Ἡρῳδιάδα | 1 | on account of Herodias | “because of Herodias” | |
434 | MRK | 6 | 17 | sf6r | translate-names | τὴν γυναῖκα Φιλίππου, τοῦ ἀδελφοῦ αὐτοῦ | 1 | the wife of his brother Philip | Herod’s **brother Philip** is not the same Philip who was an evangelist in the book of Acts or the Philip who was one of Jesus’ twelve disciples. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
435 | MRK | 6 | 17 | yn6x | ὅτι αὐτὴν ἐγάμησεν | 1 | because he married her | “because Herod had married her” | |
436 | MRK | 6 | 19 | x35v | figs-metonymy | ἤθελεν αὐτὸν ἀποκτεῖναι, καὶ οὐκ ἠδύνατο | 1 | was wanting to kill him, but she was not able | Herodias is the subject of this phrase and **she** is a metonym as she wants someone else to execute John. Alternate translation: “she wanted someone to kill him, but she could not have him killed” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
437 | MRK | 6 | 20 | k8wa | grammar-connect-words-phrases | ὁ γὰρ Ἡρῴδης ἐφοβεῖτο τὸν Ἰωάννην, εἰδὼς | 1 | for Herod was fearing John, knowing | These two clauses can be linked differently to show more clearly why Herod feared John. Alternate translation: “for Herod feared John because he knew” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/grammar-connect-words-phrases]]) |
438 | MRK | 6 | 20 | fj95 | εἰδὼς αὐτὸν ἄνδρα δίκαιον καὶ ἅγιον | 1 | knowing him to be a righteous and holy man | “because Herod knew that John was a righteous and holy man” | |
439 | MRK | 6 | 20 | i5de | ἀκούσας αὐτοῦ | 1 | having heard him | “having listened to John” | |
440 | MRK | 6 | 21 | xi2t | writing-background | 0 | Connecting Statement: | The author continues to give background information about Herod and the beheading of John the Baptist. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) | |
441 | MRK | 6 | 21 | m54q | figs-metonymy | Ἡρῴδης τοῖς γενεσίοις αὐτοῦ δεῖπνον ἐποίησεν, τοῖς μεγιστᾶσιν αὐτοῦ | 1 | Herod prepared his birthday dinner for his officials | Here, **Herod** is a metonym for his servants whom he would have commanded to prepare a meal. Alternate translation: “Herod had his servants prepare a dinner for his officials” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
442 | MRK | 6 | 21 | h5x9 | τοῖς γενεσίοις αὐτοῦ δεῖπνον | 1 | his birthday dinner | a formal meal or banquet to celebrate his birthday | |
443 | MRK | 6 | 22 | a1d7 | figs-rpronouns | τῆς θυγατρὸς αὐτοῦ Ἡρῳδιάδος | 1 | the daughter of Herodias herself | The word **herself** is a reflexive pronoun used to emphasize that it was significant that it was Herodias’ own daughter who danced at the dinner. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rpronouns]]) |
444 | MRK | 6 | 22 | nir8 | εἰσελθούσης | 1 | having entered | “having come into the room” | |
445 | MRK | 6 | 23 | qr1w | ἐάν με αἰτήσῃς, δώσω σοι, ἕως ἡμίσους τῆς βασιλείας μου | 1 | Whatever you may ask of me, I will give you, up to half of my kingdom | “I will give you up to half of what I own and rule, if you ask for it” | |
446 | MRK | 6 | 24 | jky3 | ἐξελθοῦσα | 1 | having gone out | “after she went out of the room” | |
447 | MRK | 6 | 25 | ap2w | πίνακι | 1 | a platter | “a board” or “a large wooden dish” | |
448 | MRK | 6 | 26 | c1gn | figs-explicit | διὰ τοὺς ὅρκους καὶ τοὺς συνανακειμένους | 1 | because of his oath and those reclining at table with him | The content of the **oath**, and the relationship between the oath and the dinner guests can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “because his dinner guests had heard him make the oath that he would give her anything she asked for” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
449 | MRK | 6 | 28 | k51v | ἐπὶ πίνακι | 1 | on a platter | “on a tray” | |
450 | MRK | 6 | 29 | f3xg | ἀκούσαντες, οἱ μαθηταὶ αὐτοῦ | 1 | his disciples, having heard of this | “John’s disciples, having heard that this had happened” | |
451 | MRK | 6 | 30 | gm4a | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After the disciples return from preaching and healing, they go somewhere to be alone, but there are many people who come to hear Jesus teach. When it becomes late, he feeds the people and then sends everyone away while he prays alone. | ||
452 | MRK | 6 | 31 | wu9z | ἔρημον τόπον | 1 | a desolate place | a place where there are no people | |
453 | MRK | 6 | 31 | p1c9 | ἦσαν…οἱ ἐρχόμενοι καὶ οἱ ὑπάγοντες πολλοί | 1 | those coming and those going were many | This means that people were continually **coming** to the apostles and then **going** away from them. | |
454 | MRK | 6 | 31 | a8q1 | οὐδὲ…εὐκαίρουν | 1 | they were not even having opportunity | The word **they** refers to the apostles. | |
455 | MRK | 6 | 32 | dp4l | καὶ ἀπῆλθον | 1 | And they went away | Here the word **they** includes both the apostles and Jesus. | |
456 | MRK | 6 | 33 | x5un | εἶδον αὐτοὺς ὑπάγοντας, καὶ ἐπέγνωσαν πολλοί | 1 | many saw them leaving and recognized them | “many people saw Jesus and the apostles leaving and recognized them” | |
457 | MRK | 6 | 33 | r1jh | πεζῇ | 1 | on foot | The people are going **on foot** by land, which contrasts with how the disciples went by boat. | |
458 | MRK | 6 | 34 | b7zp | εἶδεν πολὺν ὄχλον | 1 | he saw a great crowd | “Jesus saw a great crowd” | |
459 | MRK | 6 | 34 | j1td | figs-simile | ἦσαν ὡς πρόβατα μὴ ἔχοντα ποιμένα | 1 | they were like sheep not having a shepherd | Jesus compares the people to **sheep** who are confused when they do not have their **shepherd** to lead them. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]]) |
460 | MRK | 6 | 35 | sei9 | figs-idiom | καὶ ἤδη ὥρας πολλῆς γενομένης | 1 | And the hour already having become late | This means it was late in the day. Alternate translation: “And when it was getting late” or “And late in the afternoon” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
461 | MRK | 6 | 35 | hz4h | ἔρημός ἐστιν ὁ τόπος | 1 | This place is desolate | This refers to a place where there are no people. See how you translated this in [Mark 6:31](../06/31.md). | |
462 | MRK | 6 | 37 | am7m | ὁ δὲ ἀποκριθεὶς εἶπεν αὐτοῖς | 1 | But answering, he said to them | “But Jesus answered and said to his disciples” | |
463 | MRK | 6 | 37 | cts5 | figs-rquestion | ἀπελθόντες, ἀγοράσωμεν δηναρίων διακοσίων ἄρτους, καὶ δώσομεν αὐτοῖς φαγεῖν? | 1 | Having gone away, might we buy 200 denarii of loaves of bread and give it to them to eat? | The disciples ask this question to say that there is no way they could afford to buy enough food for this crowd. Alternate translation: “We could not buy enough bread to feed this crowd, even if we had two hundred denarii!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
464 | MRK | 6 | 37 | hs21 | translate-bmoney | δηναρίων διακοσίων | 1 | 200 denarii | The singular form of the word **denarii** is “denarius.” A denarius was a Roman silver coin worth one day’s wages. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]]) |
465 | MRK | 6 | 37 | c65w | translate-numbers | δηναρίων διακοσίων | 1 | 200 denarii | “two hundred denarii” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
466 | MRK | 6 | 38 | h61r | ἄρτους | 1 | loaves | lumps of bread dough that have been shaped and baked | |
467 | MRK | 6 | 39 | xgb6 | τῷ χλωρῷ χόρτῳ | 1 | the green grass | Describe the **grass** with the color word used in your language for healthy grass, which may or may not be the color **green**. | |
468 | MRK | 6 | 40 | e4cb | figs-explicit | πρασιαὶ, κατὰ ἑκατὸν καὶ κατὰ πεντήκοντα | 1 | by group according to hundreds and according to fifties | This refers to the number of people in each of the groups. Alternate translation: “about fifty people in some groups and about a hundred people in other groups” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
469 | MRK | 6 | 41 | l8q3 | ἀναβλέψας εἰς τὸν οὐρανὸν | 1 | having looked up to heaven | This means that he **looked up** toward the sky, which is associated with the place where God lives. | |
470 | MRK | 6 | 41 | gr6v | εὐλόγησεν | 1 | he blessed | “he spoke a blessing” or “he gave thanks” | |
471 | MRK | 6 | 41 | r49p | τοὺς δύο ἰχθύας ἐμέρισεν πᾶσιν | 1 | he divided the two fish among them all | “he divided the two fish so that everyone could have some” | |
472 | MRK | 6 | 43 | rq7a | ἦραν | 1 | they took up | This could mean: (1) “the disciples took up” or (2) “the people took up.” | |
473 | MRK | 6 | 43 | sk2v | κλάσματα δώδεκα κοφίνων πληρώματα | 1 | 12 baskets full of broken pieces | “twelve baskets full of broken pieces of bread” | |
474 | MRK | 6 | 43 | xk9h | translate-numbers | δώδεκα κοφίνων | 1 | 12 baskets | “twelve baskets” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
475 | MRK | 6 | 44 | v4m3 | translate-numbers | πεντακισχίλιοι ἄνδρες | 1 | 5,000 men | “five thousand men” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
476 | MRK | 6 | 44 | u413 | figs-explicit | ἦσαν οἱ φαγόντες τοὺς ἄρτους, πεντακισχίλιοι ἄνδρες | 1 | those who ate the loaves were 5,000 men | The number of women and children was not counted. If it would not be understood that women and children were present, it can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “And there were 5,000 men who ate the loaves. They did not even count the women and children” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
477 | MRK | 6 | 45 | bc6z | figs-ellipsis | εἰς τὸ πέραν | 1 | to the other side | This refers to the Sea of Galilee. This can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “to the other side of the Sea of Galilee” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
478 | MRK | 6 | 45 | y3ve | translate-names | Βηθσαϊδάν | 1 | Bethsaida | This is a town on the northern shore of the Sea of Galilee. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
479 | MRK | 6 | 46 | l6az | ἀποταξάμενος αὐτοῖς | 1 | having sent them away | “when he had sent the people away” | |
480 | MRK | 6 | 48 | rvu4 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | A storm arises while the disciples are trying to cross the lake. Seeing Jesus walking on the water terrifies them. They do not understand how Jesus can calm the storm. | ||
481 | MRK | 6 | 48 | g7ka | translate-ordinal | τετάρτην φυλακὴν | 1 | the fourth watch | This is the time between 3 a.m. and sunrise. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]]) |
482 | MRK | 6 | 49 | s8cd | φάντασμά | 1 | a ghost | the spirit of a dead person or some other kind of spirit | |
483 | MRK | 6 | 50 | et5c | figs-parallelism | θαρσεῖτε…μὴ φοβεῖσθε | 1 | Take courage! … Do not fear! | These two sentences are similar in meaning, emphasizing to his disciples that they did not need to be afraid. They can be combined into one if necessary. Alternate translation: “Do not be afraid of me!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]]) |
484 | MRK | 6 | 51 | u2u6 | figs-explicit | λείαν ἐν ἑαυτοῖς ἐξίσταντο | 1 | they were completely amazed among themselves | If you need to be more specific, it can stated what they were amazed by. Alternate translation: “they were completely amazed at what he had done” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
485 | MRK | 6 | 52 | m53m | figs-metonymy | ἐπὶ τοῖς ἄρτοις | 1 | about the loaves | Here the phrase **the loaves** refers to when Jesus multiplied the loaves of bread. Alternate translation: “what it meant when Jesus multiplied the loaves of bread” or “what it meant when Jesus caused the few loaves to become many” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
486 | MRK | 6 | 52 | t1qb | figs-metaphor | ἦν αὐτῶν ἡ καρδία πεπωρωμένη | 1 | their heart had been hardened | A **heart** that has been **hardened** represents being too stubborn to understand. Alternate translation: “they were too stubborn to understand” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
487 | MRK | 6 | 53 | rc3z | 0 | Connecting Statement: | When Jesus and his disciples arrive at Gennesaret in their boat, people see him and bring people for him to heal. This happens wherever they go. | ||
488 | MRK | 6 | 53 | p316 | translate-names | Γεννησαρὲτ | 1 | Gennesaret | This is the name of the region to the northwest of the Sea of Galilee. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
489 | MRK | 6 | 55 | e7fh | figs-explicit | περιέδραμον ὅλην τὴν χώραν ἐκείνην | 1 | they ran throughout that whole region | It may be helpful to state why they ran through the region. Alternate translation: “they ran throughout the whole district in order to tell others that Jesus was there” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
490 | MRK | 6 | 55 | d9k9 | περιέδραμον…ἤκουον | 1 | they ran throughout … they were hearing | The word **they** refers to the people who recognized Jesus, not to the disciples. | |
491 | MRK | 6 | 55 | wr7f | figs-nominaladj | τοὺς κακῶς ἔχοντας | 1 | those having sickness | This phrase refers to people. Alternate translation: “the sick people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]]) |
492 | MRK | 6 | 56 | bjv5 | ὅπου ἂν εἰσεπορεύετο | 1 | wherever he was entering | “wherever Jesus entered” | |
493 | MRK | 6 | 56 | gi6y | ἐτίθεσαν | 1 | they were putting | Here, **they** refers to the people. It does not refer to Jesus’ disciples. | |
494 | MRK | 6 | 56 | y6hs | figs-nominaladj | τοὺς ἀσθενοῦντας | 1 | the sick | This phrase refers to people. Alternate translation: “the sick people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]]) |
495 | MRK | 6 | 56 | a3i3 | παρεκάλουν αὐτὸν | 1 | were begging him | This could mean: (1) “the sick were begging him” or (2) “the people were begging him.” | |
496 | MRK | 6 | 56 | m366 | ἅψωνται | 1 | they might touch | The word **they** refers to the sick. | |
497 | MRK | 6 | 56 | wd2u | τοῦ κρασπέδου τοῦ ἱματίου αὐτοῦ | 1 | the edge of his garment | “the hem of his robe” or “the edge of his clothes” | |
498 | MRK | 6 | 56 | ugr3 | ὅσοι ἂν | 1 | as many as | “all those who” | |
499 | MRK | 7 | intro | vq1j | 0 | # Mark 07 General Notes<br><br>## Structure and formatting<br><br>Some translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 7:6-7, which are words from the Old Testament.<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### Hand washing<br><br>The Pharisees washed many things that were not dirty because they were trying to make God think that they were good. They washed their hands before they ate, even when their hands were not dirty. and even though the law of Moses did not say that they had to do it. Jesus told them that they were wrong and that people make God happy by thinking and doing the right things. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/lawofmoses]] and [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/clean]])<br><br>## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter<br><br>### “Ephphatha”<br><br>This is an Aramaic word. Mark wrote it the way it sounds using Greek letters and then explained what it means. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]]) | |||
500 | MRK | 7 | 1 | hu3f | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus rebukes the Pharisees and scribes. | ||
501 | MRK | 7 | 1 | b9ul | συνάγονται πρὸς αὐτὸν | 1 | are gathering around him | “are gathered around Jesus” | |
502 | MRK | 7 | 2 | b8qw | writing-background | 0 | General Information: | In verses 3 and 4, the author gives background information about the Pharisees’ washing traditions in order to show why the Pharisees were bothered that Jesus’ disciples did not wash their hands before eating. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) | |
503 | MRK | 7 | 2 | wd6i | translate-versebridge | 0 | General Information: | Verses 3 and 4 can be reordered in order to make it easier to understand, as in the UST. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-versebridge]]) | |
504 | MRK | 7 | 2 | a2qf | ἰδόντες | 1 | they had seen | “the Pharisees and the scribes saw” | |
505 | MRK | 7 | 2 | eea5 | figs-activepassive | τοῦτ’ ἔστιν ἀνίπτοις | 1 | that is, unwashed | The word **unwashed** explains why the disciples’ hands were defiled. It can be expressed in active form. Alternate translation: “that is, with hands that they had not washed” or “that is, that they had not washed their hands” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
506 | MRK | 7 | 3 | mj6u | τῶν πρεσβυτέρων | 1 | of the elders | Jewish **elders** were leaders in their communities and were also judges for the people. | |
507 | MRK | 7 | 4 | wsb8 | χαλκίων | 1 | copper vessels | “copper kettles” or “metal containers” | |
508 | MRK | 7 | 5 | hts4 | figs-metaphor | διὰ τί οὐ περιπατοῦσιν οἱ μαθηταί σου κατὰ τὴν παράδοσιν τῶν πρεσβυτέρων, ἀλλὰ κοιναῖς χερσὶν ἐσθίουσιν τὸν ἄρτον? | 1 | Why do your disciples not walk according to the tradition of the elders, but they eat their bread with unwashed hands? | **Walk in** here is a metaphor for “obey.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
509 | MRK | 7 | 5 | ugom | figs-rquestion | διὰ τί οὐ περιπατοῦσιν οἱ μαθηταί σου κατὰ τὴν παράδοσιν τῶν πρεσβυτέρων, ἀλλὰ κοιναῖς χερσὶν ἐσθίουσιν τὸν ἄρτον? | 1 | Why do your disciples not walk according to the tradition of the elders, but they eat their bread with unwashed hands? | The Pharisees and scribes asked this question to challenge Jesus’ authority. This can be written as two statements. Alternate translation: “Your disciples disobey the traditions of our elders! They should wash their hands using our rituals.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
510 | MRK | 7 | 5 | j7ht | figs-synecdoche | ἄρτον | 1 | bread | This is a synecdoche, representing food in general. Alternate translation: “food” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
511 | MRK | 7 | 6 | t7px | 0 | General Information: | Here Jesus quotes the prophet Isaiah, who had written scripture many years earlier. | ||
512 | MRK | 7 | 6 | ep7u | figs-metonymy | τοῖς χείλεσίν | 1 | with their lips | Here, **lips** is a metonym for speaking. Alternate translation: “by what they say” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
513 | MRK | 7 | 6 | zgt9 | figs-metonymy | ἡ δὲ καρδία αὐτῶν πόρρω ἀπέχει ἀπ’ ἐμοῦ | 1 | but their heart is far from me | Here, **heart** refers to a person’s thoughts or emotions. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
514 | MRK | 7 | 6 | xtab | figs-idiom | ἡ δὲ καρδία αὐτῶν πόρρω ἀπέχει ἀπ’ ἐμοῦ | 1 | but their heart is far from me | This is a way of saying the people are not truly devoted to God. Alternate translation: “but they do not really love me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
515 | MRK | 7 | 7 | f8q5 | μάτην δὲ σέβονταί με | 1 | But they worship me in vain | “But they offer me useless worship” | |
516 | MRK | 7 | 8 | yqj3 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus continues to rebuke the scribes and Pharisees. | ||
517 | MRK | 7 | 8 | xz71 | ἀφέντες | 1 | Having abandoned | having refused to obey | |
518 | MRK | 7 | 8 | hnw4 | κρατεῖτε | 1 | you hold fast to | “you hold strongly to” or “you only keep” | |
519 | MRK | 7 | 9 | e3qv | figs-irony | καλῶς ἀθετεῖτε τὴν ἐντολὴν τοῦ Θεοῦ, ἵνα τὴν παράδοσιν ὑμῶν τηρήσητε | 1 | How well you reject the commandment of God so that you may keep your tradition! | Jesus uses this ironic statement to rebuke his listeners for forsaking God’s **commandment**. Alternate translation: “You think you have done well in how you have rejected the commandment of God so you may keep your own traditions, but what you have done is not good at all” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]]) |
520 | MRK | 7 | 9 | r5li | καλῶς ἀθετεῖτε | 1 | How well you reject | “How skillfully you reject” | |
521 | MRK | 7 | 10 | d4sd | ὁ κακολογῶν πατέρα | 1 | The one speaking evil of his father | “The one who curses his father” | |
522 | MRK | 7 | 10 | ayl3 | θανάτῳ τελευτάτω | 1 | let him die the death | “he must surely be put to death” | |
523 | MRK | 7 | 10 | dv6e | figs-activepassive | ὁ κακολογῶν πατέρα ἢ μητέρα θανάτῳ τελευτάτω | 1 | The one speaking evil of his father or mother—let him die the death | This may be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “The authorities must surely execute a person who speaks evil about his father or mother” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
524 | MRK | 7 | 11 | q76i | κορβᾶν…ὃ ἐὰν ἐξ ἐμοῦ ὠφεληθῇς | 1 | Whatever you would have profited from me is Corban | The tradition of the scribes said that once money or other things were promised to the temple, they could not be used for any other purpose. | |
525 | MRK | 7 | 11 | cd57 | translate-transliterate | κορβᾶν | 1 | is Corban | **Corban** is a Hebrew word that refers to things that people promise to give to God. Translators normally transliterate it using the target language alphabet. Some translators translate its meaning, and then leave out Mark’s explanation of the meaning that follows. Alternate translation: “is a gift to God” or “belongs to God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]]) |
526 | MRK | 7 | 11 | ev2r | figs-activepassive | ὅ ἐστιν δῶρον | 1 | that is, a gift | This phrase explains the meaning of the Hebrew word “Corban.” It can be stated in active form. Mark explained the meaning so that his non-Jewish readers could understand what Jesus said. Alternate translation: “I have given it to God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
527 | MRK | 7 | 12 | g18b | translate-versebridge | 0 | General Information: | In verses 11 and 12, Jesus shows how the Pharisees teach people that they do not have to obey God’s commandment to honor their parents. In verse 11 Jesus tells what the Pharisees allow people to say about their possessions, and in verse 12 he tells how that shows the Pharisees’ attitude toward people helping their parents. This information can be reordered to first tell about the Pharisees’ attitude toward people helping their parents and then tell how that attitude is shown in what the Pharisees allow people to say about their possessions. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-versebridge]]) | |
528 | MRK | 7 | 12 | cb8c | figs-explicit | οὐκέτι ἀφίετε αὐτὸν οὐδὲν ποιῆσαι τῷ πατρὶ ἢ τῇ μητρί | 1 | you no longer permit him to do anything for his father or his mother | By doing this, the Pharisees are allowing people not to provide for their parents, if they promise to give to God what they would have given to them. You can order these words before the words that begin with “Whatever help” in verse 11: “You no longer permit a person to do anything for his father or his mother after he says, ‘Whatever help you would have received from me is Corban.’ (Corban means ‘Given to God.’)” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
529 | MRK | 7 | 13 | df13 | ἀκυροῦντες | 1 | nullifying | cancelling or doing away with | |
530 | MRK | 7 | 13 | ena5 | παρόμοια τοιαῦτα πολλὰ ποιεῖτε | 1 | you do many such similar things | “you are doing may other things similar to this” | |
531 | MRK | 7 | 14 | wp7p | figs-parables | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus tells a parable to the crowd to help them understand what he has been saying to the scribes and Pharisees. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]]) | |
532 | MRK | 7 | 14 | ts15 | προσκαλεσάμενος | 1 | having called | “after Jesus had called” | |
533 | MRK | 7 | 14 | u3nk | figs-doublet | ἀκούσατέ μου πάντες καὶ σύνετε | 1 | Listen to me, all of you, and understand | The words **Listen** and **understand** are related. Jesus uses them together to emphasize that his hearers should pay close attention to what he is saying. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]]) |
534 | MRK | 7 | 14 | yni7 | figs-ellipsis | σύνετε | 1 | understand | It may be helpful to state what Jesus is telling them to **understand**. Alternate translation: “try to understand what I am about to tell you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
535 | MRK | 7 | 15 | gk5i | figs-explicit | οὐδέν…ἔξωθεν τοῦ ἀνθρώπου | 1 | nothing from outside the man | Jesus is speaking about what a person eats. This is in contrast to “what come out of the person.” Alternate translation: “nothing from outside a person that he can eat” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
536 | MRK | 7 | 15 | ms5c | figs-explicit | τὰ ἐκ τοῦ ἀνθρώπου ἐκπορευόμενά | 1 | the things that come out from the man | This refers to the things a person does or says. This is in contrast to “what is outside a person that enters into him.” Alternate translation: “It is what comes out of a person that he says or does” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
537 | MRK | 7 | 17 | m42w | 0 | Connecting Statement: | The disciples still do not understand what Jesus has just said to the scribes, Pharisees, and crowds. Jesus explains his meaning more thoroughly to them. | ||
538 | MRK | 7 | 17 | l7d7 | καὶ | 1 | And | The word **And** marks a break in the main story line. Jesus is now away from the crowd, in a house with his disciples. | |
539 | MRK | 7 | 18 | f5sf | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus begins to teach his disciples by asking a question. | ||
540 | MRK | 7 | 18 | z8w1 | figs-rquestion | οὕτως καὶ ὑμεῖς ἀσύνετοί ἐστε? | 1 | Are you also thus without understanding? | Jesus uses this question to express his disappointment that they do not understand. This can be expressed as a statement. Alternate translation: “After all I have said and done, I would expect you to understand.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
541 | MRK | 7 | 19 | wyw4 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus finishes asking the question he is using to teach his disciples. | ||
542 | MRK | 7 | 19 | wi6y | figs-rquestion | ὅτι οὐκ εἰσπορεύεται αὐτοῦ εἰς τὴν καρδίαν, ἀλλ’ εἰς τὴν κοιλίαν, καὶ εἰς τὸν ἀφεδρῶνα ἐκπορεύεται? | 1 | because it does not go into his heart, but into his stomach, and then passes out into the latrine? | This is the end of the question that begins with the words “Do you not see” in verse 18. Jesus uses this question to teach his disciples something they should already know. It can be expressed as a statement. “You should already understand that whatever enters into a person from outside cannot defile him, because it cannot go into his heart, but it goes into his stomach and then passes out into the latrine.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
543 | MRK | 7 | 19 | y2cr | figs-metonymy | οὐκ εἰσπορεύεται αὐτοῦ εἰς τὴν καρδίαν | 1 | it does not go into his heart | Here, **heart** is a metonym for a person’s inner being or mind. Here Jesus means that food does not affect a person’s character. Alternate translation: “it cannot go into his inner being” or “it cannot go into his mind” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
544 | MRK | 7 | 19 | he68 | οὐκ εἰσπορεύεται | 1 | it does not go | Here, **it** refers to what goes into a person; that is, what a person eats. | |
545 | MRK | 7 | 19 | hm98 | figs-explicit | καθαρίζων πάντα τὰ βρώματα | 1 | making all foods clean | It may be helpful to explain clearly what this phrase means. Alternate translation: “all foods clean, meaning that people can eat any food without God considering the eater defiled” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
546 | MRK | 7 | 20 | r12p | ἔλεγεν | 1 | he was saying | “Jesus said” | |
547 | MRK | 7 | 20 | eq3a | τὸ ἐκ τοῦ ἀνθρώπου ἐκπορευόμενον, ἐκεῖνο κοινοῖ τὸν ἄνθρωπον | 1 | What is coming out from the man, that defiles the man | “What defiles a person is what comes out of him” | |
548 | MRK | 7 | 21 | lm51 | figs-metonymy | ἐκ τῆς καρδίας τῶν ἀνθρώπων οἱ διαλογισμοὶ οἱ κακοὶ ἐκπορεύονται | 1 | out of the heart of men, proceed evil thoughts | Here, **heart** is a metonym for a person’s inner being or mind. Alternate translation: “out of the inner being of a person, come evil thoughts” or “out of the mind of a person, come evil thoughts” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
549 | MRK | 7 | 22 | y3md | ἀσέλγεια | 1 | sensuality | not controlling one’s lustful desires | |
550 | MRK | 7 | 23 | h9ta | figs-ellipsis | ἔσωθεν ἐκπορεύεται | 1 | come out from within | Here the word **within** describes a person’s heart. Alternate translation: “come from within a person’s heart” or “come from within a person’s thoughts” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
551 | MRK | 7 | 24 | k9bl | 0 | Connecting Statement: | When Jesus goes away to Tyre, he heals the daughter of a Gentile woman who has extraordinary faith. | ||
552 | MRK | 7 | 25 | j2k9 | figs-idiom | εἶχεν…πνεῦμα ἀκάθαρτον | 1 | having an unclean spirit | This is an idiom meaning that she was possessed by the unclean spirit. Alternate translation: “being possessed by an unclean spirit” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
553 | MRK | 7 | 25 | q47q | προσέπεσεν | 1 | fell down | “knelt.” This is an act of honor and submission. | |
554 | MRK | 7 | 26 | aik7 | writing-background | ἡ δὲ γυνὴ ἦν Ἑλληνίς, Συροφοινίκισσα τῷ γένει | 1 | But the woman was a Greek, a Syrophoenician by descent | The word **But** marks a break in the main story line, as this sentence gives us background information about the woman. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) |
555 | MRK | 7 | 26 | e39y | translate-names | Συροφοινίκισσα | 1 | a Syrophoenician | This is the name of the woman’s nationality. She was born in the Phoenician region in Syria. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
556 | MRK | 7 | 27 | gsj7 | figs-metaphor | ἄφες πρῶτον χορτασθῆναι τὰ τέκνα; οὐ γάρ ἐστιν καλόν λαβεῖν τὸν ἄρτον τῶν τέκνων, καὶ τοῖς κυναρίοις βαλεῖν | 1 | Permit the children first be fed, for it is not good to take the bread of the children and to throw it to the dogs | Here Jesus speaks about the Jews as if they are **children** and the Gentiles as if they are **dogs**. Alternate translation: “Let the children of Israel first be fed. For it is not right to take the children’s bread and throw it to the Gentiles, who are like dogs” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
557 | MRK | 7 | 27 | r898 | figs-activepassive | ἄφες πρῶτον χορτασθῆναι τὰ τέκνα | 1 | Permit the children first to be fed | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “We must first feed the children of Israel” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
558 | MRK | 7 | 27 | k2wb | figs-synecdoche | ἄρτον | 1 | bread | This refers to food in general. Alternate translation: “food” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
559 | MRK | 7 | 27 | yn61 | τοῖς κυναρίοις | 1 | to the dogs | This refers to small dogs kept as pets. | |
560 | MRK | 7 | 29 | sa9t | figs-explicit | ὕπαγε | 1 | go | Jesus was implying that she no longer needed to stay to ask him to help her daughter. He would do it. Alternate translation: “you may go now” or “you may go home in peace” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
561 | MRK | 7 | 29 | pa3u | figs-explicit | ἐξελήλυθεν τὸ δαιμόνιον, ἐκ τῆς θυγατρός σου | 1 | The demon has gone out from your daughter | Jesus has caused the unclean spirit to leave the woman’s **daughter**. This can be expressed clearly. Alternate translation: “I have caused the evil spirit to leave your daughter” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
562 | MRK | 7 | 31 | g44h | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After healing people in Tyre, Jesus goes to the Sea of Galilee. There he heals a deaf man, which amazes the people. | ||
563 | MRK | 7 | 31 | k9gy | ἐξελθὼν ἐκ τῶν ὁρίων Τύρου | 1 | having gone out from the region of Tyre | “having left the region of Tyre” | |
564 | MRK | 7 | 31 | paz4 | ἀνὰ μέσον τῶν ὁρίων | 1 | up to a part of the region | This could mean: (1) “up to a place in the region” as Jesus is at the sea in the region of the Decapolis or (2) “through part of the region” as Jesus went through the region of the Decapolis to get to the sea. | |
565 | MRK | 7 | 31 | cxa8 | translate-names | Δεκαπόλεως | 1 | of the Decapolis | This is the name of a region that means Ten Cities. It is located to the southeast of the Sea of Galilee. See how you translated this in [Mark 5:20](../05/20.md). (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
566 | MRK | 7 | 32 | bnq6 | φέρουσιν | 1 | they bring | “the people brought” | |
567 | MRK | 7 | 32 | i5gy | κωφὸν | 1 | someone who was deaf | “a person who was not able to hear” | |
568 | MRK | 7 | 32 | jlj4 | figs-explicit | παρακαλοῦσιν αὐτὸν ἵνα ἐπιθῇ αὐτῷ τὴν χεῖρα | 1 | they beg him that he would lay his hand on him | Prophets and teachers would put their **hands on** people in order to heal them or bless them. In this case, people are begging Jesus to heal a man. Alternate translation: “they begged Jesus to put his hand on the man to heal him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
569 | MRK | 7 | 33 | p3aa | ἀπολαβόμενος αὐτὸν | 1 | having taking him aside | “after Jesus took the man aside” | |
570 | MRK | 7 | 33 | zb1w | ἔβαλεν τοὺς δακτύλους αὐτοῦ εἰς τὰ ὦτα αὐτοῦ | 1 | he put his fingers into his ears | Jesus is putting his own fingers in the man’s ears. | |
571 | MRK | 7 | 33 | jwi8 | πτύσας, ἥψατο τῆς γλώσσης αὐτοῦ | 1 | having spit, he touched his tongue | Jesus spits and then touches the man’s tongue. | |
572 | MRK | 7 | 33 | ld3f | figs-explicit | πτύσας | 1 | having spit | It may be helpful to state that Jesus **spit** on his fingers. Alternate translation: “after spitting on his fingers” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
573 | MRK | 7 | 34 | vfn4 | ἀναβλέψας εἰς τὸν οὐρανὸν | 1 | having looked up to heaven | This means that he **looked up** toward the sky, which is associated with the place where God lives. | |
574 | MRK | 7 | 34 | lbw4 | translate-transliterate | ἐφφαθά | 1 | Ephphatha | Here the author refers to something by an Aramaic word. This word should be copied as is into your language using your alphabet. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]]) |
575 | MRK | 7 | 34 | qiy7 | ἐστέναξεν | 1 | he sighed | This means that he groaned or that he let out a long deep breath that could be heard. It probably shows Jesus’ sympathy for the man. | |
576 | MRK | 7 | 34 | m4a8 | λέγει αὐτῷ | 1 | says to him | “said to the man” | |
577 | MRK | 7 | 35 | yg15 | figs-idiom | ἠνοίγησαν αὐτοῦ αἱ ἀκοαί | 1 | his ears were opened | This means he was able to hear. Alternate translation: “his ears were opened and he was able to hear” or “he was able to hear” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
578 | MRK | 7 | 35 | yj4j | figs-activepassive | ἐλύθη ὁ δεσμὸς τῆς γλώσσης αὐτοῦ | 1 | the band of his tongue was released | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Jesus took away what prevented his tongue from speaking” or “Jesus loosened his tongue” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
579 | MRK | 7 | 36 | eb2y | figs-ellipsis | ὅσον…αὐτοῖς διεστέλλετο, αὐτοὶ | 1 | as much as he ordered them | The refers to him ordering them not to tell anyone about what he had done. Alternate translation: “the more he ordered them not to tell anyone” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
580 | MRK | 7 | 36 | zce7 | μᾶλλον περισσότερον | 1 | the more abundantly | “the more widely” or “the more” | |
581 | MRK | 7 | 37 | iy76 | ὑπέρπερισσῶς ἐξεπλήσσοντο | 1 | they were extremely astonished | “they were utterly amazed” or “they were exceedingly astonished” or “they were astonished beyond all measure” | |
582 | MRK | 7 | 37 | dh17 | figs-metonymy | τοὺς κωφοὺς…ἀλάλους | 1 | the deaf … the mute | These refer to people. Alternate translation: “deaf people … mute people” or “people who cannot hear … people who cannot speak” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
583 | MRK | 8 | intro | ry56 | 0 | # Mark 08 General Notes<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### Bread<br><br>When Jesus worked a miracle and provided bread for a large crowd of people, they probably thought about when God miraculously provided food for the people of Israel when they were in the wilderness.<br><br>Yeast is the ingredient that causes bread to become larger before it is baked. In this chapter, Jesus uses yeast as a metaphor for things that change the way people think, speak, and act. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])<br><br>### “Adulterous generation”<br><br>When Jesus called the people an “adulterous generation,” he was telling them that they were not faithful to God. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/faithful]] and [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/peopleofgod]])<br><br>## Important figures of speech in this chapter<br><br>### Rhetorical Questions<br><br>Jesus used many rhetorical questions as a way of both teaching the disciples ([Mark 8:17-21](./17.md)) and scolding the people ([Mark 8:12](../../mrk/08/12.md)). (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])<br><br>## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter<br><br>### Paradox<br><br>A paradox is a true statement that appears to describe something impossible. Jesus uses a paradox when he says, “Whoever wants to save his life will lose it, and whoever loses his life for my sake will find it” ([Mark 8:35-37](./35.md)). | |||
584 | MRK | 8 | 1 | sgv6 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | A great, hungry crowd is with Jesus. He feeds them using only seven loaves and a few fish before Jesus and his disciples get in a boat to go to another place. | ||
585 | MRK | 8 | 1 | rmd8 | writing-newevent | ἐν ἐκείναις ταῖς ἡμέραις | 1 | In those days | This phrase is used to introduce a new event in the story. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-newevent]]) |
586 | MRK | 8 | 2 | h8v8 | ἤδη ἡμέραι τρεῖς προσμένουσίν μοι, καὶ οὐκ ἔχουσιν τι φάγωσιν | 1 | they are remaining with me already for three days and do not have anything to eat | “this is this third day these people have been with me, and they have nothing to eat” | |
587 | MRK | 8 | 3 | u3mu | figs-hyperbole | ἐκλυθήσονται | 1 | they will faint | This could mean: (1) literal, “they may lose consciousness temporarily” or (2) hyperbolic exaggeration, “they may become weak.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
588 | MRK | 8 | 4 | jdk2 | figs-rquestion | πόθεν τούτους δυνήσεταί τις ὧδε χορτάσαι ἄρτων ἐπ’ ἐρημίας? | 1 | From where will anyone be able to feed these people with bread here in this desolate place? | The disciples are expressing surprise that Jesus would expect them to be able to find enough food. Alternate translation: “This place is so deserted that there is no place here for us to get enough loaves of bread to satisfy these people!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
589 | MRK | 8 | 4 | b7tn | ἄρτων | 1 | with bread | Loaves of **bread** are lumps of dough that have been shaped and baked. | |
590 | MRK | 8 | 5 | m56c | ἠρώτα αὐτούς | 1 | he asked them | “Jesus asked his disciples” | |
591 | MRK | 8 | 6 | x2jr | figs-quotations | παραγγέλλει τῷ ὄχλῳ ἀναπεσεῖν ἐπὶ τῆς γῆς | 1 | he commands the crowd to recline on the ground | This can be written as a direct quote. “Jesus commanded the crowd, ‘Sit down on the ground’” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]]) |
592 | MRK | 8 | 6 | x144 | ἀναπεσεῖν | 1 | to recline | Use your language’s word for how people customarily eat when there is no table, whether sitting or lying down. | |
593 | MRK | 8 | 7 | pzy6 | καὶ εἶχαν | 1 | and they had | Here the word **they** is used to refer to Jesus and his disciples. | |
594 | MRK | 8 | 7 | mb6v | εὐλογήσας αὐτὰ | 1 | having blessed them | “after Jesus gave thanks for the fish” | |
595 | MRK | 8 | 8 | m9k6 | ἔφαγον | 1 | they ate | “the people ate” | |
596 | MRK | 8 | 8 | mxn1 | ἦραν | 1 | they picked up | Here, **they** could refer to the disciples, or to the people in the crowd. | |
597 | MRK | 8 | 8 | v5zi | figs-explicit | περισσεύματα κλασμάτων ἑπτὰ σπυρίδας | 1 | an abundance of broken pieces—seven baskets | This refers to the **broken pieces** of fish and bread that were left over after the people ate. Alternate translation: “the remaining broken pieces of bread and fish, which filled seven large baskets” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
598 | MRK | 8 | 9 | m81z | figs-explicit | καὶ ἀπέλυσεν αὐτούς | 1 | and he sent them away | It may be helpful to clarify when **he sent them away**. Alternate translation: “and after they ate, Jesus sent them away” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
599 | MRK | 8 | 10 | y8u3 | figs-explicit | ἦλθεν εἰς τὰ μέρη Δαλμανουθά | 1 | he went into the region of Dalmanutha | It may be helpful to clarify how they got to Dalmanutha. Alternate translation: “he sailed around the Sea of Galilee to the region of Dalmanutha” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
600 | MRK | 8 | 10 | x33a | translate-names | Δαλμανουθά | 1 | of Dalmanutha | This is the name of a place on the northwestern shore of the Sea of Galilee. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
601 | MRK | 8 | 11 | cqy5 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | In Dalmanutha, Jesus refuses to give the Pharisees a sign before he and his disciples get in a boat and leave. | ||
602 | MRK | 8 | 11 | f9y8 | ζητοῦντες παρ’ αὐτοῦ | 1 | seeking from him | “asking him for” | |
603 | MRK | 8 | 11 | zi91 | figs-metonymy | σημεῖον ἀπὸ τοῦ οὐρανοῦ | 1 | a sign from heaven | They wanted **a sign** that would prove that Jesus’ power and authority were from God. This could mean: (1) the word **heaven** is a metonym for God. Alternate translation: “a sign from God” or (2) the word **heaven** refers to the sky. Alternate translation: “a sign from the sky” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
604 | MRK | 8 | 11 | cl3q | figs-explicit | πειράζοντες αὐτόν | 1 | testing him | The Pharisees tried to test Jesus to make him prove that he was from God. Some information can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “to prove that God had sent him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
605 | MRK | 8 | 12 | sn5a | ἀναστενάξας τῷ πνεύματι αὐτοῦ | 1 | having sighed deeply in his spirit | This means that he groaned or that he let out a long deep breath that could be heard. It probably shows Jesus’ deep sadness that the Pharisees refused to believe him. See how you translated this in [Mark 7:34](../07/34.md). | |
606 | MRK | 8 | 12 | s8xl | τῷ πνεύματι αὐτοῦ | 1 | in his spirit | “in himself” | |
607 | MRK | 8 | 12 | g4lz | figs-rquestion | τί ἡ γενεὰ αὕτη ζητεῖ σημεῖον? | 1 | Why does this generation seek for a sign? | Jesus is scolding them. This question may be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “This generation should not seek a sign.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
608 | MRK | 8 | 12 | l335 | figs-explicit | τί ἡ γενεὰ αὕτη ζητεῖ | 1 | Why does this generation seek for | When Jesus speaks of **this generation**, he is referring to the people who lived at that time. The Pharisees are included in this group. Alternate translation: “Why do you and the people of this generation seek for” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
609 | MRK | 8 | 12 | a2x2 | figs-activepassive | εἰ δοθήσεται…σημεῖον | 1 | if a sign will be given | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “I will not give a sign” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
610 | MRK | 8 | 13 | i2se | figs-explicit | ἀφεὶς αὐτοὺς, πάλιν ἐμβὰς | 1 | having left them, having boarded a boat again | Jesus’ disciples went with him. Some information can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “after he left them and got into a boat again with his disciples” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
611 | MRK | 8 | 13 | u1qk | figs-explicit | εἰς τὸ πέραν | 1 | to the other side | This describes the Sea of Galilee, which can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “to the other side of the sea” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
612 | MRK | 8 | 14 | fl8d | 0 | Connecting Statement: | While Jesus and his disciples are in a boat, they have a discussion about the lack of understanding among the Pharisees and Herod, though they had seen many signs. | ||
613 | MRK | 8 | 14 | m74g | writing-background | καὶ | 1 | And | Here, **And** marks a break in the main story line. Here the author tells background information about the disciples forgetting to bring bread. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) |
614 | MRK | 8 | 14 | gtg6 | figs-litotes | εἰ μὴ ἕνα ἄρτον | 1 | except for one loaf | The negative phrase **except for** is used to emphasize how small an amount of bread they had. Alternate translation: “only one loaf” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]]) |
615 | MRK | 8 | 15 | bd2x | figs-doublet | ὁρᾶτε, βλέπετε | 1 | Keep watch! Be on guard | These two terms have a common meaning and are repeated here for emphasis. They can be combined. Alternate translation: “Keep watch” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]]) |
616 | MRK | 8 | 15 | ya88 | figs-metaphor | τῆς ζύμης τῶν Φαρισαίων καὶ τῆς ζύμης Ἡρῴδου | 1 | the yeast of the Pharisees and the yeast of Herod | Here Jesus is speaking to his disciples in a metaphor they do not understand. Jesus is comparing the Pharisees’ and Herod’s teachings to **yeast**, but you should not explain this when you translate it because the disciples themselves did not understand it. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
617 | MRK | 8 | 16 | xs4p | figs-explicit | ὅτι ἄρτους οὐκ ἔχουσιν | 1 | that they have no bread | In this statement, it may be helpful to state what they thought Jesus had meant when he spoke to them about **bread**. Alternate translation: “that he must have said that because they had no bread” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
618 | MRK | 8 | 16 | zfw3 | figs-hyperbole | ἄρτους οὐκ ἔχουσιν | 1 | they have no bread | The word **no** is an exaggeration. The disciples did have one loaf of bread ([Mark 8:14](../08/14.md)), but that was not much different from having no bread at all. Alternate translation: “very little bread” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
619 | MRK | 8 | 17 | hnh6 | figs-rquestion | τί διαλογίζεσθε ὅτι ἄρτους οὐκ ἔχετε? | 1 | Why are you reasoning that you do not have bread? | Here Jesus is mildly rebuking his disciples because they should have understood what he had been talking about. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “You should not be thinking that I am talking about actual bread.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
620 | MRK | 8 | 17 | dmt2 | figs-parallelism | οὔπω νοεῖτε, οὐδὲ συνίετε? | 1 | Do you not yet perceive, nor understand? | These questions have the same meaning and are used together to emphasize that they do not understand. This can be written as one question. Alternate translation: “Do you not yet understand?” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]]) |
621 | MRK | 8 | 17 | wf6j | figs-rquestion | οὔπω νοεῖτε, οὐδὲ συνίετε? | 1 | Do you not yet perceive, nor understand? | This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “You should perceive and understand by now the things I say and do.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
622 | MRK | 8 | 17 | fn31 | figs-metonymy | πεπωρωμένην ἔχετε τὴν καρδίαν ὑμῶν? | 1 | Have your hearts become hardened? | Here, **hearts** is a metonym for a person’s mind. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
623 | MRK | 8 | 17 | rq8c | figs-metaphor | πεπωρωμένην ἔχετε τὴν καρδίαν ὑμῶν? | 1 | Have your hearts become hardened? | The phrase **hearts become hardened** is a metaphor for not being able or willing to understand something. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
624 | MRK | 8 | 17 | mihv | figs-rquestion | πεπωρωμένην ἔχετε τὴν καρδίαν ὑμῶν? | 1 | Have your hearts become hardened? | Jesus uses a question to scold the disciples. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “Your thinking has become so dull!” or “You are so slow to understand what I mean!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
625 | MRK | 8 | 18 | u1gh | figs-rquestion | ὀφθαλμοὺς ἔχοντες, οὐ βλέπετε? καὶ ὦτα ἔχοντες, οὐκ ἀκούετε? καὶ οὐ μνημονεύετε? | 1 | Having eyes, do you not see? And having ears, do you not hear? And do you not remember? | Jesus continues to mildly rebuke his disciples. These questions can be written as statements. Alternate translation: “You have eyes, but you do not understand what you see. You have ears, but you do not understand what you hear. You should remember.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
626 | MRK | 8 | 19 | e37p | figs-metonymy | τοὺς πεντακισχιλίους | 1 | the 5,000 | This refers to the 5,000 people Jesus fed. Alternate translation: “the 5,000 people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
627 | MRK | 8 | 19 | t7ig | translate-numbers | τοὺς πεντακισχιλίους | 1 | the 5,000 | “the five thousand people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
628 | MRK | 8 | 19 | e4zq | figs-explicit | πόσους κοφίνους κλασμάτων πλήρεις ἤρατε | 1 | how many baskets full of broken pieces did you take up | It may be helpful to state when they collected the baskets of pieces. Alternate translation: “how many baskets full of broken pieces of bread did you collect after everyone finished eating” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
629 | MRK | 8 | 20 | b5bm | figs-metonymy | τοὺς τετρακισχιλίους | 1 | the 4,000 | This refers to the 4,000 people Jesus fed. Alternate translation: “the 4,000 people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
630 | MRK | 8 | 20 | lip5 | translate-numbers | τοὺς τετρακισχιλίους | 1 | the 4,000 | “the four thousand people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
631 | MRK | 8 | 20 | ggl1 | figs-explicit | πόσων σπυρίδων πληρώματα κλασμάτων ἤρατε | 1 | how many baskets full of broken pieces did you take up | It may be helpful to state when they collected these. Alternate translation: “how many baskets full of broken pieces of bread did you collect after everyone finished eating” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
632 | MRK | 8 | 21 | kh42 | figs-rquestion | πῶς οὔπω συνίετε? | 1 | How do you not yet understand? | Jesus is mildly rebuking his disciples for not understanding. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “You should understand by now the things I say and do.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
633 | MRK | 8 | 22 | c92c | 0 | Connecting Statement: | When Jesus and his disciples get out of their boat at Bethsaida, Jesus heals a blind man. | ||
634 | MRK | 8 | 22 | mul4 | translate-names | Βηθσαϊδάν | 1 | Bethsaida | This is a town on the northern shore of the Sea of Galilee. See how you translated the name of this town in [Mark 6:45](../06/45.md). (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
635 | MRK | 8 | 22 | mx9q | figs-explicit | ἵνα αὐτοῦ ἅψηται | 1 | that he would touch him | It may be helpful to state why they wanted Jesus to touch the man. Alternate translation: “to touch him in order to heal him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
636 | MRK | 8 | 23 | t5ud | πτύσας εἰς τὰ ὄμματα αὐτοῦ, ἐπιθεὶς τὰς χεῖρας αὐτῷ, ἐπηρώτα αὐτόν | 1 | having spit into his eyes, having laid his hands on him, he was asking him | “when Jesus had spit on the man’s eyes and laid his hands on him, Jesus asked the man” | |
637 | MRK | 8 | 24 | jcv8 | ἀναβλέψας | 1 | having looked up | “when the man looked up” | |
638 | MRK | 8 | 24 | r6tk | figs-simile | βλέπω τοὺς ἀνθρώπους, ὅτι ὡς δένδρα ὁρῶ περιπατοῦντας | 1 | I see men who look like walking trees | The man sees men **walking** around, yet they are not clear to him, so he compares them to **trees**. Alternate translation: “Yes, I see people! They are walking around, but I cannot see them clearly. They look like trees” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]]) |
639 | MRK | 8 | 25 | png5 | εἶτα πάλιν ἐπέθηκεν | 1 | Then he again laid | “Then Jesus again laid” | |
640 | MRK | 8 | 25 | td9l | figs-activepassive | καὶ διέβλεψεν καὶ ἀπεκατέστη | 1 | and he looked intently and was restored | The phrase **was restored** can be written in active form. Alternate translation: “restoring the man’s sight, and then the man opened his eyes” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
641 | MRK | 8 | 27 | e4l3 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus and his disciples talk on their way to the villages of Caesarea Philippi about who Jesus is and what will happen to him. | ||
642 | MRK | 8 | 28 | bh7h | οἱ δὲ εἶπαν αὐτῷ λέγοντες | 1 | But they said to him, saying | “But they answered him, saying,” | |
643 | MRK | 8 | 28 | ac8h | figs-explicit | Ἰωάννην τὸν Βαπτιστήν | 1 | John the Baptist | The disciples answer that this was who some people said Jesus was. This can be shown more clearly. Alternate translation: “Some people say that you are John the Baptist” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
644 | MRK | 8 | 28 | nn1f | figs-ellipsis | ἄλλοι…ἄλλοι | 1 | other … others | The tow occurrences of **others** refers to other people. This refers to their responses to Jesus’ question. Alternate translation: “other people say you are…other people say you are” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
645 | MRK | 8 | 29 | v4h4 | αὐτὸς ἐπηρώτα αὐτούς | 1 | He asked them | “Jesus asked his disciples” | |
646 | MRK | 8 | 30 | fk1z | figs-explicit | ἐπετίμησεν αὐτοῖς ἵνα μηδενὶ λέγωσιν περὶ αὐτοῦ | 1 | he warned them that they might tell no one about him | Jesus did not want them to tell anyone that he was the Christ. This can be made more explicit. Alternate translation: “Jesus warned them not to tell anyone that he is the Christ” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
647 | MRK | 8 | 30 | rgy8 | figs-quotations | ἐπετίμησεν αὐτοῖς ἵνα μηδενὶ λέγωσιν περὶ αὐτοῦ | 1 | he warned them that they might tell no one about him | This can be written as a direct quote. Alternate translation: “Jesus warned them, ‘Do not tell anyone that I am the Christ’” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]]) |
648 | MRK | 8 | 31 | d4dc | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | τὸν Υἱὸν τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου | 1 | the Son of Man | This is an important title for Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
649 | MRK | 8 | 31 | m32p | figs-activepassive | ἀποδοκιμασθῆναι ὑπὸ τῶν πρεσβυτέρων καὶ τῶν ἀρχιερέων καὶ τῶν γραμματέων, καὶ ἀποκτανθῆναι, καὶ μετὰ τρεῖς ἡμέρας ἀναστῆναι | 1 | to be rejected by the elders and the chief priests and the scribes, and to be killed, and to rise up after three days | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “that the elders and the chief priests and the scribes would reject him, and that men would kill him, and that after three days he would rise up” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
650 | MRK | 8 | 32 | hl4a | παρρησίᾳ τὸν λόγον ἐλάλει | 1 | he was speaking this word openly | “he said this in a way that was easy to understand” | |
651 | MRK | 8 | 32 | te4z | figs-explicit | ἤρξατο ἐπιτιμᾶν αὐτῷ | 1 | began to rebuke him | Peter rebuked Jesus for saying the things he said would happen to the Son of Man. This can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “began to rebuke him for saying these things” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
652 | MRK | 8 | 33 | ev5s | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After rebuking Peter for his not wanting Jesus to die and rise, Jesus tells both his disciples and the crowd how to follow him. | ||
653 | MRK | 8 | 33 | nu32 | figs-metaphor | ὕπαγε ὀπίσω μου, Σατανᾶ, ὅτι οὐ φρονεῖς | 1 | Get behind me, Satan! For you are not setting your mind | Jesus means that Peter is acting like **Satan** because Peter is trying to prevent Jesus from accomplishing what God sent him to do. Alternate translation: “Get behind me, because you are acting like Satan! You are not setting” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
654 | MRK | 8 | 33 | r9gy | ὕπαγε ὀπίσω μου | 1 | Get behind me | “Get away from me” | |
655 | MRK | 8 | 34 | m732 | figs-metaphor | ὀπίσω μου ἀκολουθεῖν | 1 | to follow after me | To **follow** Jesus here represents being one of his disciples. Alternate translation: “be my disciple” or “be one of my disciples” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
656 | MRK | 8 | 34 | skl2 | ἀπαρνησάσθω ἑαυτὸν | 1 | let him deny himself | “he must not give in to his own desires” or “he must forsake his own desires” | |
657 | MRK | 8 | 34 | c6ll | figs-metonymy | ἀράτω τὸν σταυρὸν αὐτοῦ, καὶ ἀκολουθείτω μοι | 1 | take up his cross, and follow me | The cross represents suffering and death. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
658 | MRK | 8 | 34 | oxv6 | figs-metaphor | ἀράτω τὸν σταυρὸν αὐτοῦ, καὶ ἀκολουθείτω μοι | 1 | take up his cross, and follow me | “carry his cross and follow me.” Taking up the cross represents being willing to suffer and die. Alternate translation: “must obey me even to the point of suffering and dying” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
659 | MRK | 8 | 34 | zs3l | figs-metaphor | ἀκολουθείτω μοι | 1 | follow me | To **follow** Jesus here represents obeying him. Alternate translation: “obey me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
660 | MRK | 8 | 35 | d5rj | ὃς γὰρ ἐὰν θέλῃ | 1 | For whoever wants | “For anyone who wants” | |
661 | MRK | 8 | 35 | a6g3 | τὴν ψυχὴν | 1 | soul | This refers to both physical life and spiritual life. | |
662 | MRK | 8 | 35 | mpq6 | figs-explicit | ἕνεκεν ἐμοῦ καὶ τοῦ εὐαγγελίου | 1 | for my sake and for the gospel | “because of me and because of the gospel.” Jesus is talking about people who lose their lives because they follow Jesus and **the gospel**. This can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “because he follows me and tells others the gospel” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
663 | MRK | 8 | 36 | ua46 | figs-rquestion | τί γὰρ ὠφελεῖ ἄνθρωπον, κερδήσῃ τὸν κόσμον ὅλον καὶ ζημιωθῆναι τὴν ψυχὴν αὐτοῦ? | 1 | For what does it profit a man to gain the whole world and to forfeit his soul? | This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “Even if a person gains the whole world, it will not benefit him if he forfeits his life.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
664 | MRK | 8 | 36 | w7gm | κερδήσῃ τὸν κόσμον ὅλον καὶ ζημιωθῆναι τὴν ψυχὴν αὐτοῦ | 1 | to gain the whole world and to forfeit his soul | This can also be expressed as a condition starting with the word “if.” Alternate translation: “if he gains the whole world and then forfeits his life” | |
665 | MRK | 8 | 36 | jde6 | figs-hyperbole | κερδήσῃ τὸν κόσμον ὅλον | 1 | to gain the whole world | The words **the whole world** are an exaggeration for great riches. Alternate translation: “to gain everything he ever wanted” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
666 | MRK | 8 | 36 | bu77 | ζημιωθῆναι | 1 | to forfeit | To **forfeit** something is to lose it or to have another person take it away. | |
667 | MRK | 8 | 37 | wua4 | figs-rquestion | τί γὰρ δοῖ ἄνθρωπος ἀντάλλαγμα τῆς ψυχῆς αὐτοῦ? | 1 | For what might a man give as an exchange for his soul? | This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “There is nothing a person can give in exchange for his life.” or “No one can give anything in exchange for his life.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
668 | MRK | 8 | 37 | zw4j | τί…δοῖ ἄνθρωπος | 1 | what might a man give | If in your language to **give** requires someone to receive what is given, “God” can be stated as the receiver. Alternate translation: “what can a person give to God” | |
669 | MRK | 8 | 38 | rvi6 | ἐπαισχυνθῇ με καὶ τοὺς ἐμοὺς λόγους | 1 | may be ashamed of me and my words | “may be ashamed of me and my message” | |
670 | MRK | 8 | 38 | c53y | figs-metaphor | ἐν τῇ γενεᾷ ταύτῃ, τῇ μοιχαλίδι καὶ ἁμαρτωλῷ | 1 | in this adulterous and sinful generation | Jesus speaks of this **generation** as **adulterous**, meaning that they are unfaithful in their relationship with God. Alternate translation: “in this generation of people who have committed adultery against God and are very sinful” or “in this generation of people who are unfaithful to God and are very sinful” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
671 | MRK | 8 | 38 | s5tm | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου | 1 | the Son of Man | This is an important title for Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
672 | MRK | 8 | 38 | xd58 | ὅταν ἔλθῃ | 1 | when he may come | “when he comes back” | |
673 | MRK | 8 | 38 | vl69 | ἐν τῇ δόξῃ τοῦ Πατρὸς αὐτοῦ | 1 | in the glory of his Father | When Jesus returns he will have the same **glory** as his Father. | |
674 | MRK | 8 | 38 | vqk3 | μετὰ τῶν ἀγγέλων τῶν ἁγίων | 1 | with the holy angels | “accompanied by the holy angels” | |
675 | MRK | 9 | intro | n92j | 0 | # Mark 09 General Notes<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### “transfigured”<br><br>Scripture often speaks of God’s glory as a great, brilliant light. When people see this light, they are afraid. Mark says in this chapter that Jesus’ clothing shone with this glorious light so that his followers could see that Jesus truly was God’s Son. At the same time, God told them that Jesus was his Son. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/glory]] and [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/fear]])<br><br>## Important figures of speech in this chapter<br><br>### Hyperbole<br><br>Jesus said things that he did not expect his followers to understand literally. When he said, “If your hand causes you to stumble, cut it off” ([Mark 9:43](../../mrk/09/43.md)), he was exaggerating so they would know that they should stay away from anything that caused them to sin, even if it was something they loved or thought they needed.<br><br>## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter<br><br>### Elijah and Moses<br><br>Elijah and Moses suddenly appear to Jesus, James, John, and Peter, and then they disappear. All four of them saw Elijah and Moses, and because Elijah and Moses spoke with Jesus, the reader should understand that Elijah and Moses appeared physically.<br><br>### “Son of Man”<br><br>Jesus refers to himself as the “Son of Man” in this chapter ([Mark 9:31](../../mrk/09/31.md)). Your language may not allow people to speak of themselves as if they were speaking about someone else. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/sonofman]] and [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])<br><br>### Paradox<br><br>A paradox is a true statement that appears to describe something impossible. Jesus uses a paradox when he says, “If anyone wants to be first, he must be last of all and servant of all” ([Mark 9:35](../../mrk/09/35.md)). | |||
676 | MRK | 9 | 1 | mt8p | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus has just been talking to the people and his disciples about following him. Six days later, Jesus goes with three of his disciples up a mountain where his appearance temporarily changes to what he will look like one day in the kingdom of God. | ||
677 | MRK | 9 | 1 | q4b6 | ἔλεγεν αὐτοῖς | 1 | he was saying to them | “Jesus said to his disciples” | |
678 | MRK | 9 | 1 | yjf6 | figs-metonymy | τὴν Βασιλείαν τοῦ Θεοῦ ἐληλυθυῖαν ἐν δυνάμει | 1 | the kingdom of God come with power | The kingdom of God coming represents God showing himself as king. Alternate translation: “God show himself with great power as king” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
679 | MRK | 9 | 2 | uf5f | figs-rpronouns | κατ’ ἰδίαν μόνους | 1 | by themselves, alone | The author uses the reflexive pronoun **themselves** here to emphasize that they were alone and that only Jesus, Peter, James, and John went up the mountain. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rpronouns]]) |
680 | MRK | 9 | 2 | krt6 | μετεμορφώθη ἔμπροσθεν αὐτῶν | 1 | he was transfigured before them | When they looked at him, his appearance was different from what it had been. | |
681 | MRK | 9 | 2 | b3bb | figs-activepassive | μετεμορφώθη | 1 | he was transfigured | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “his appearance had changed” or “he appeared very different” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
682 | MRK | 9 | 2 | i9vm | ἔμπροσθεν αὐτῶν | 1 | before them | “in front of them” or “so they could clearly him” | |
683 | MRK | 9 | 3 | id6l | στίλβοντα | 1 | radiantly | “shining” or “glowing.” Jesus’ garments were so white they were emitting or giving off light. | |
684 | MRK | 9 | 3 | s2qf | λείαν | 1 | extremely | as much as possible or more than most | |
685 | MRK | 9 | 3 | gp48 | οἷα γναφεὺς ἐπὶ τῆς γῆς οὐ δύναται οὕτως λευκᾶναι | 1 | as no bleacher on earth is able thus to make them white | Bleaching describes the process of making natural white wool even whiter by using chemicals like bleach or ammonia. Alternate translation: “whiter than any person on earth could whiten them” | |
686 | MRK | 9 | 4 | f2d6 | figs-explicit | ὤφθη…Ἠλείας σὺν Μωϋσεῖ | 1 | Elijah with Moses appeared | It may be helpful to state who these men are. Alternate translation: “two prophets who had lived long ago, Elijah and Moses, appeared” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
687 | MRK | 9 | 4 | pj3i | ἦσαν συνλαλοῦντες | 1 | they were talking with | The word **they** refers to Elijah and Moses. | |
688 | MRK | 9 | 5 | w6vs | ἀποκριθεὶς ὁ Πέτρος λέγει τῷ Ἰησοῦ | 1 | answering, Peter says to Jesus | “Peter said to Jesus.” Here the word **answering** is used to introduce Peter into the conversation. Peter was not answering a question. | |
689 | MRK | 9 | 5 | iqc9 | figs-exclusive | καλόν ἐστιν ἡμᾶς ὧδε εἶναι | 1 | it is good for us to be here | It is not clear whether “us” refers only to Peter, James, and John, or if it refers to everyone there, including Jesus, Elijah, and Moses. If you can translate so that both options are possible, do so. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]]) |
690 | MRK | 9 | 5 | k3y1 | σκηνάς | 1 | shelters | simple, temporary places in which to sit or sleep | |
691 | MRK | 9 | 6 | r3bn | writing-background | οὐ γὰρ ᾔδει τί ἀποκριθῇ; ἔκφοβοι γὰρ ἐγένοντο | 1 | For he did not know what to say, for they were terrified | This parenthetical sentence tells background information about Peter, James, and John. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) |
692 | MRK | 9 | 6 | f8hn | ἔκφοβοι…ἐγένοντο | 1 | they were terrified | “they were very frightened” or “they were very afraid” | |
693 | MRK | 9 | 7 | e3id | ἐγένετο…ἐπισκιάζουσα αὐτοῖς | 1 | came, overshadowing them | “appeared and covered them” | |
694 | MRK | 9 | 7 | x4mv | figs-metonymy | ἐγένετο φωνὴ ἐκ τῆς νεφέλης | 1 | a voice came from the cloud | Here, **a voice came** is a metonym for someone speaking. Alternate translation: “someone spoke from the cloud” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
695 | MRK | 9 | 7 | zo2r | figs-explicit | ἐγένετο φωνὴ ἐκ τῆς νεφέλης | 1 | a voice came from the cloud | It can be stated clearly who spoke. Alternate translation: “God spoke from the cloud” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
696 | MRK | 9 | 7 | hn9m | οὗτός ἐστιν ὁ Υἱός μου, ὁ ἀγαπητός, ἀκούετε αὐτοῦ | 1 | This is my Son, the Beloved. Listen to him | God the Father expresses his love for **the Beloved**, the Son of God. | |
697 | MRK | 9 | 7 | ybu6 | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | ὁ Υἱός μου | 1 | my Son | This is an important title for Jesus, the Son of God. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
698 | MRK | 9 | 8 | hq73 | οὐκέτι…εἶδον | 1 | they no longer saw | Here, **they** refers to Peter, James, and John. | |
699 | MRK | 9 | 9 | dv4d | figs-explicit | διεστείλατο αὐτοῖς ἵνα μηδενὶ ἃ εἶδον διηγήσωνται, εἰ μὴ ὅταν ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου ἐκ νεκρῶν ἀναστῇ | 1 | he ordered them so that they would relate to no one what they had seen, until the Son of Man would rise from the dead | This implies that he was permitting them to tell people about what they had seen only after he rose from being dead. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
700 | MRK | 9 | 9 | w98g | figs-metonymy | ἐκ νεκρῶν ἀναστῇ | 1 | would rise from the dead | “would rise from among the dead.” This speaks of becoming alive again. The phrase **the dead** refers to “dead people” and is a metonym for death. Alternate translation: “risen from death” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
701 | MRK | 9 | 10 | wfu9 | figs-metonymy | ἐκ νεκρῶν ἀναστῆναι | 1 | to rise from the dead | “to rise from among the dead.” This speaks of becoming alive again. The phrase **the dead** refers to “dead people” and is a metonym for death. Alternate translation: “rising from death” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
702 | MRK | 9 | 10 | b8y9 | figs-idiom | καὶ τὸν λόγον ἐκράτησαν πρὸς ἑαυτοὺς | 1 | And they kept the word to themselves | Here, **kept the word to themselves** is an idiom that means they did not tell anyone about what they had seen. Alternate translation: “And they did not tell anyone about what they had seen” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
703 | MRK | 9 | 11 | pck1 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Though Peter, James, and John wondered what Jesus might mean by “rising from the dead,” they asked him instead about Elijah’s coming. | ||
704 | MRK | 9 | 11 | s9zn | ἐπηρώτων αὐτὸν | 1 | they were questioning him | The word **they** refers to Peter, James, and John. | |
705 | MRK | 9 | 11 | h45a | figs-explicit | λέγουσιν οἱ γραμματεῖς ὅτι Ἠλείαν δεῖ ἐλθεῖν πρῶτον? | 1 | Why do the scribes say that it is necessary for Elijah to come first? | Prophecy foretold that **Elijah** would **come** again from heaven. Then the Messiah, who is the Son of Man, would come to rule and reign. The disciples are confused about how the Son of Man could die and rise again. Alternate translation: “Why do the scribes say that Elijah must come first before the Messiah comes?” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
706 | MRK | 9 | 12 | x5ep | Ἠλείας μὲν ἐλθὼν πρῶτον ἀποκατιστάνει πάντα | 1 | Elijah has come first to restore all things | By saying this, Jesus affirms that **Elijah** had **come first**. | |
707 | MRK | 9 | 12 | s3q3 | figs-rquestion | καὶ πῶς γέγραπται ἐπὶ τὸν Υἱὸν τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου, ἵνα πολλὰ πάθῃ καὶ ἐξουδενηθῇ? | 1 | And how is it written about the Son of Man that he would suffer many things and would be despised? | Jesus uses this question to remind his disciples that the scriptures also teach that the Son of Man must suffer and be despised. This may be expressed as a statement. Alternate translation: “But I also want you to consider what is written about the Son of Man. The scriptures say that he must suffer many things and be hated.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
708 | MRK | 9 | 12 | i3j7 | figs-activepassive | ἐξουδενηθῇ | 1 | would be despised | This may be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “people would hate him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
709 | MRK | 9 | 13 | k3kj | figs-explicit | ἐποίησαν αὐτῷ ὅσα ἤθελον | 1 | they did whatever they wanted to him | It may be helpful to state what people did to Elijah. Alternate translation: “our leaders treated him very badly, just as they wanted to do” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
710 | MRK | 9 | 14 | qn7d | 0 | Connecting Statement: | When Peter, James, John, and Jesus came down from the mountain, they found the scribes arguing with the other disciples. | ||
711 | MRK | 9 | 14 | n8fd | ἐλθόντες πρὸς τοὺς μαθητὰς | 1 | having come to the disciples | Jesus, Peter, James, and John returned to the other **disciples** who had not gone with them up the mountain. | |
712 | MRK | 9 | 14 | cs1f | εἶδον ὄχλον πολὺν περὶ αὐτοὺς | 1 | they saw a great crowd around them | “Jesus and those three disciples saw a great crowd around the other disciples” | |
713 | MRK | 9 | 14 | wp9z | γραμματεῖς συνζητοῦντας πρὸς αὐτούς | 1 | scribes arguing with them | The scribes were arguing with the disciples who had not gone with Jesus. | |
714 | MRK | 9 | 15 | lch5 | figs-explicit | ἐξεθαμβήθησαν | 1 | were amazed | It may be helpful to state why they **were amazed**. Alternate translation: “was amazed that Jesus had come” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
715 | MRK | 9 | 17 | b7v8 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | To explain what the scribes and other disciples were arguing about, a father of a demon-possessed man tells Jesus that he has asked the disciples to send the demon out of his son, but they could not. Jesus then casts the demon out of the boy. Later the disciples ask why they were not able to send the demon away. | ||
716 | MRK | 9 | 17 | zqw9 | figs-idiom | ἔχοντα πνεῦμα ἄλαλον | 1 | having a mute spirit | This means the boy is possessed by an unclean spirit that made him unable to speak. Alternate translation: “having an unclean spirit that prevented him from speaking” or “being possessed by an unclean spirit that makes him mute” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
717 | MRK | 9 | 18 | zhc9 | ἀφρίζει | 1 | he foams at the mouth | A convulsion, or seizure, can cause a person to have trouble breathing or swallowing. This causes white foam to come out of the mouth. If your language has a way to describe that, you could use it. Alternate translation: “bubbles come out of his mouth” | |
718 | MRK | 9 | 18 | h98h | ξηραίνεται | 1 | he becomes rigid | “he becomes stiff” or “his body becomes rigid” | |
719 | MRK | 9 | 18 | zre6 | figs-ellipsis | οὐκ ἴσχυσαν | 1 | they could not | This refers to the disciples not being about to drive the spirit out of the boy. Alternate translation: “they could not drive it out of him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
720 | MRK | 9 | 19 | tb67 | figs-explicit | ὁ…ἀποκριθεὶς αὐτοῖς λέγει | 1 | answering them, he says | Though it was the boy’s father who made a request of Jesus, Jesus responds to the whole crowd. This can be made clear. Alternate translation: “Jesus responded to the crowd and said” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
721 | MRK | 9 | 19 | azc9 | ὦ γενεὰ ἄπιστος | 1 | You unbelieving generation | “You unbelieving generation.” Jesus calls the crowd this, as he begins to respond to them. | |
722 | MRK | 9 | 19 | n4dq | figs-parallelism | ἕως πότε πρὸς ὑμᾶς ἔσομαι? ἕως πότε ἀνέξομαι ὑμῶν? | 1 | until when will I be with you? Until when will I bear with you? | Both questions have the same meaning. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]]) |
723 | MRK | 9 | 19 | c88a | figs-rquestion | ἕως πότε πρὸς ὑμᾶς ἔσομαι? ἕως πότε ἀνέξομαι ὑμῶν? | 1 | until when will I be with you? Until when will I bear with you? | Jesus uses these questions to express his frustration. They can be written as statements. Alternate translation: “I have become weary by your unbelief!” or “Your unbelief tires me! I wonder how long I must bear with you.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
724 | MRK | 9 | 19 | b7u5 | ἀνέξομαι ὑμῶν | 1 | will I bear with you | “should I endure you” or “must I put up with you” | |
725 | MRK | 9 | 19 | b7ee | φέρετε αὐτὸν πρός με | 1 | Bring him to me | “Bring the boy to me” | |
726 | MRK | 9 | 20 | bw3l | τὸ πνεῦμα | 1 | the spirit | This refers to the unclean spirit. See how you translated this in [Mark 9:17](../09/17.md). | |
727 | MRK | 9 | 20 | l4r5 | συνεσπάραξεν αὐτόν | 1 | threw him into a convulsion | This is a condition where a person has no control over his body, and his body shakes violently. | |
728 | MRK | 9 | 21 | f5zm | figs-ellipsis | ἐκ παιδιόθεν | 1 | From childhood | “Since he was a small child.” It may be helpful to state this as a full sentence. Alternate translation: “He has been like this since he was a small child” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
729 | MRK | 9 | 22 | f5yu | σπλαγχνισθεὶς | 1 | having had compassion | “feeling compassion” | |
730 | MRK | 9 | 23 | vh6c | figs-ellipsis | εἰ δύνῃ? | 1 | ‘If you are able’? | Jesus repeated what the man had said to him. Alternate translation: “Do you say to me ‘If you are able’?” or “Why do you say ‘If you are able’?” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
731 | MRK | 9 | 23 | g3nd | figs-rquestion | εἰ δύνῃ? | 1 | ‘If you are able’? | Jesus used this question to rebuke the man’s doubt. It can be expressed as a statement. Alternate translation: “You should not say to me, ‘If you are able.’” or “You ask me if I am able. Of course I am able.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
732 | MRK | 9 | 23 | kp1x | πάντα δυνατὰ τῷ πιστεύοντι | 1 | All things are possible for the one believing | “God can do anything for people who believe in him” | |
733 | MRK | 9 | 23 | f3uj | τῷ πιστεύοντι | 1 | for the one believing | “for the person who believes” or “for anyone who believes” | |
734 | MRK | 9 | 23 | e5kk | τῷ πιστεύοντι | 1 | for the one believing | This refers to belief in God. Alternate translation: “for the one who believes in God” | |
735 | MRK | 9 | 24 | h4y6 | βοήθει μου τῇ ἀπιστίᾳ | 1 | Help me in my unbelief | The man is asking Jesus to help him overcome his unbelief and increase his faith. Alternate translation: “Help me when I do not believe” or “Help me have more faith” | |
736 | MRK | 9 | 25 | qaw4 | ἐπισυντρέχει ὄχλος | 1 | the crowd is running to them | This means that more people were **running** toward where Jesus was and that the crowd there was growing larger. | |
737 | MRK | 9 | 25 | ul8k | τὸ ἄλαλον καὶ κωφὸν πνεῦμα | 1 | You mute and deaf spirit | The words **mute** and **deaf** can be explained. Alternate translation: “You unclean spirit, you who are causing the boy to be unable to speak and unable to hear” | |
738 | MRK | 9 | 26 | adb6 | κράξας | 1 | having cried out | “after the unclean spirit cried out” | |
739 | MRK | 9 | 26 | i8dz | πολλὰ σπαράξας, αὐτόν | 1 | convulsed him greatly | “shook him violently” | |
740 | MRK | 9 | 26 | ry3l | figs-explicit | ἐξῆλθεν | 1 | it came out | It is implied that the spirit **came out** of the boy. Alternate translation: “it came out of the boy” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
741 | MRK | 9 | 26 | n7h8 | figs-simile | ἐγένετο ὡσεὶ νεκρὸς | 1 | he became like a dead person | The boy’s appearance is compared to that of **a dead person**. Alternate translation: “the boy appeared dead” or “the boy looked like a dead person” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]]) |
742 | MRK | 9 | 26 | ns4t | ὥστε τοὺς πολλοὺς | 1 | so that many | “so that many people” | |
743 | MRK | 9 | 27 | g2lt | figs-idiom | κρατήσας τῆς χειρὸς αὐτοῦ | 1 | having taken him by his hand | This means that Jesus grasped the boy’s hand with his own **hand**. Alternate translation: “having grasped the boy by the hand” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
744 | MRK | 9 | 27 | r9zn | ἤγειρεν αὐτόν | 1 | lifted him up | “helped him get up” | |
745 | MRK | 9 | 28 | sd45 | κατ’ ἰδίαν | 1 | by himself | “privately.” This means he was alone with them. | |
746 | MRK | 9 | 28 | x1ej | figs-ellipsis | ἐκβαλεῖν αὐτό | 1 | cast it out | “cast the unclean spirit out.” This refers to casting the spirit out of the boy. Alternate translation: “cast the unclean spirit out of the boy” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
747 | MRK | 9 | 29 | pdk2 | figs-doublenegatives | τοῦτο τὸ γένος ἐν οὐδενὶ δύναται ἐξελθεῖν, εἰ μὴ ἐν προσευχῇ καὶ νηστείᾳ | 1 | This kind comes out by nothing except by prayer and fasting | The words **nothing** and **except** are both negative words. In some languages it is more natural to use a positive statement. Alternate translation: “This kind can be cast out only by prayer and fasting” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]]) |
748 | MRK | 9 | 29 | v2s7 | figs-ellipsis | τοῦτο τὸ γένος | 1 | This kind | This describes unclean spirits. Alternate translation: “This kind of unclean spirit” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
749 | MRK | 9 | 30 | q4iu | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After he heals the demon-possessed boy, Jesus and his disciples leave the house where they are staying. He takes time to teach his disciples alone. | ||
750 | MRK | 9 | 30 | pp6z | κἀκεῖθεν ἐξελθόντες | 1 | And having gone out from there | “And after Jesus and his disciples left that region” | |
751 | MRK | 9 | 30 | f12g | παρεπορεύοντο διὰ | 1 | they were passing through | “they traveled through” or “they passed by” | |
752 | MRK | 9 | 31 | ywi8 | figs-explicit | ἐδίδασκεν γὰρ τοὺς μαθητὰς αὐτοῦ | 1 | for he was teaching his disciples | Jesus **was teaching his disciples** privately, away from the crowd. This can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “for he was teaching his disciples privately” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
753 | MRK | 9 | 31 | w75k | figs-activepassive | ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου παραδίδοται | 1 | The Son of Man is being delivered | This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “Someone is going to deliver the Son of Man” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
754 | MRK | 9 | 31 | y5cw | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου παραδίδοται | 1 | The Son of Man is being delivered | Here Jesus refers to himself as the **Son of Man**. This is an important title for Jesus. “I, the Son of Man, am being delivered” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
755 | MRK | 9 | 31 | z8ud | figs-metonymy | εἰς χεῖρας ἀνθρώπων | 1 | into the hands of men | Here, **hands** is a metonym for control. Alternate translation: “into the control of men” or “so that men will be able to control him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
756 | MRK | 9 | 31 | s1n2 | figs-activepassive | ἀποκτανθεὶς, μετὰ τρεῖς ἡμέρας ἀναστήσεται | 1 | having been killed, he will rise again after three days | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “after they have put him to death and three days have passed, he will rise from the dead” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
757 | MRK | 9 | 32 | vtx1 | figs-ellipsis | ἐφοβοῦντο αὐτὸν ἐπερωτῆσαι | 1 | they were afraid to ask him | They **were afraid to ask** Jesus what his statement meant. Alternate translation: “they were afraid to ask him what it meant” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
758 | MRK | 9 | 33 | xv94 | writing-newevent | 0 | Connecting Statement: | When they come to Capernaum, Jesus teaches his disciples about being humble servants. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-newevent]]) | |
759 | MRK | 9 | 33 | swa7 | ἦλθον εἰς | 1 | they came to | “they arrived at.” The word **they** refers to Jesus and his disciples. | |
760 | MRK | 9 | 33 | t717 | διελογίζεσθε | 1 | were you discussing | “were you discussing with one another” | |
761 | MRK | 9 | 34 | sq3c | figs-explicit | οἱ…ἐσιώπων | 1 | they were silent | They **were silent** because they were ashamed to tell Jesus what they had been discussing. Alternate translation: “they were silent because they were ashamed” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
762 | MRK | 9 | 34 | gdg3 | figs-explicit | τίς μείζων | 1 | about who was the greatest | Here, **the greatest** refers to “the greatest” among the disciples. Alternate translation: “about who was the greatest among them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
763 | MRK | 9 | 35 | jzl5 | figs-metaphor | εἴ τις θέλει πρῶτος εἶναι, ἔσται πάντων ἔσχατος | 1 | If anyone wants to be first, he will be last of all | Here the words **first** and **last** are opposites of one another. Jesus speaks of being the “most important” as being **first** and of being the “least important” as being **last**. Alternate translation: “If anyone wants God to consider him to be the most important person of all, he must consider himself to be the least important of all” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
764 | MRK | 9 | 35 | t526 | πάντων | -1 | of all … of all | “of all people … of all people” | |
765 | MRK | 9 | 36 | gmb1 | ἐν μέσῳ αὐτῶν | 1 | in their midst | “among them.” The word **their** refers to the crowd. | |
766 | MRK | 9 | 36 | idb8 | ἐναγκαλισάμενος αὐτὸ | 1 | having taken him in his arms | This means that he hugged the child or picked him up and held him. | |
767 | MRK | 9 | 37 | h242 | ἓν τῶν τοιούτων παιδίων | 1 | one of these little children | “a child like this” | |
768 | MRK | 9 | 37 | ul12 | figs-idiom | ἐπὶ τῷ ὀνόματί μου | 1 | in my name | This means to do something because of love for Jesus. Alternate translation: “because he loves me” or “for my sake” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
769 | MRK | 9 | 37 | y24n | figs-explicit | τὸν ἀποστείλαντά με | 1 | the one who has sent me | This refers to God, who has sent him to earth. Alternate translation: “God, who has sent me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
770 | MRK | 9 | 38 | idn7 | ἔφη αὐτῷ ὁ Ἰωάννης | 1 | John was saying to him | “John said to Jesus” | |
771 | MRK | 9 | 38 | tn6s | figs-explicit | ἐκβάλλοντα δαιμόνια | 1 | casting out demons | “sending away demons.” This refers to **casting** **demons** out of people. Alternate translation: “casting demons out of people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
772 | MRK | 9 | 38 | dxq5 | figs-metonymy | ἐν τῷ ὀνόματί σου | 1 | in your name | Here, **name** is associated with Jesus’ authority and power. Alternate translation: “by the authority of your name” or “by the power of your name” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
773 | MRK | 9 | 38 | k2i2 | figs-idiom | οὐκ ἠκολούθει ἡμῖν | 1 | he was not following us | This means that he is not among their group of disciples. Alternate translation: “he is not one of us” or “he does not walk with us” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
774 | MRK | 9 | 40 | tma4 | οὐκ ἔστιν καθ’ ἡμῶν | 1 | is not against us | “is not opposing us” | |
775 | MRK | 9 | 40 | j8gq | ὑπὲρ ἡμῶν ἐστιν | 1 | is for us | It can be explained clearly what this means. Alternate translation: “is trying to achieve the same goals that we are” | |
776 | MRK | 9 | 41 | lz5d | figs-metaphor | ποτίσῃ ὑμᾶς ποτήριον ὕδατος ἐν ὀνόματι, ὅτι Χριστοῦ ἐστε | 1 | may give you a cup of water in the name that you are of Christ | Jesus speaks about giving someone **a cup of water** as an example of how one person may help another. This is a metaphor for helping someone in any way. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
777 | MRK | 9 | 41 | bgq1 | figs-litotes | οὐ μὴ ἀπολέσῃ | 1 | he may certainly not lose | This negative sentence emphasizes the positive meaning. In some languages, it is more natural to use a positive statement. Alternate translation: “he will definitely receive” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]]) |
778 | MRK | 9 | 42 | z6k5 | μύλος ὀνικὸς | 1 | a large millstone | a large, round stone used for grinding grain into flour | |
779 | MRK | 9 | 43 | g8dv | figs-metonymy | ἐὰν σκανδαλίσῃ σε ἡ χείρ σου | 1 | if your hand may cause you to stumble | Here, **hand** is a metonym for desiring to do something sinful that you would do with your hand. Alternate translation: “if you want to do something sinful with one of your hands” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
780 | MRK | 9 | 43 | iku4 | κυλλὸν εἰσελθεῖν εἰς τὴν ζωὴν | 1 | to enter into life maimed | “to be maimed and then to enter into life” or “to be maimed before entering into life” | |
781 | MRK | 9 | 43 | g6ww | figs-metaphor | εἰσελθεῖν εἰς τὴν ζωὴν | 1 | to enter into life | Dying and then beginning to live eternally is spoken of as entering **into life**. Alternate translation: “to enter into eternal life” or “to die and begin to live forever” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
782 | MRK | 9 | 43 | qjm9 | κυλλὸν | 1 | maimed | missing a body part as a result of having it removed or being injured. Here it refers to missing a hand. Alternate translation: “without a hand” or “missing a hand” | |
783 | MRK | 9 | 43 | ttl7 | εἰς τὸ πῦρ τὸ ἄσβεστον | 1 | into the unquenchable fire | “where the fire cannot be put out” | |
784 | MRK | 9 | 45 | lx2b | figs-metonymy | ἐὰν ὁ πούς σου σκανδαλίζῃ σε | 1 | if your foot may cause you to stumble | Here the word **foot** is a metonym for desiring to do something sinful that you would do with your feet, such as going to a place you should not go to. Alternate translation: “if you want to do something sinful with one of your feet” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
785 | MRK | 9 | 45 | vj49 | εἰσελθεῖν εἰς τὴν ζωὴν χωλὸν | 1 | to enter into life lame | “to be lame and then to enter into life” or “to be lame before entering into life” | |
786 | MRK | 9 | 45 | r1dy | figs-metaphor | εἰσελθεῖν εἰς τὴν ζωὴν | 1 | to enter into life | Dying and then beginning to live eternally is spoken of as entering **into life**. Alternate translation: “to enter into eternal life” or “to die and begin to live forever” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
787 | MRK | 9 | 45 | c2vw | χωλὸν | 1 | lame | “unable to walk easily.” Here it refers not being able to walk well because of missing a foot. Alternate translation: “without a foot” or “missing a foot” | |
788 | MRK | 9 | 45 | tmd6 | figs-activepassive | βληθῆναι εἰς τὴν Γέενναν | 1 | to be thrown into hell | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “for God to throw you into hell” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
789 | MRK | 9 | 47 | n5tw | figs-metonymy | ἐὰν ὁ ὀφθαλμός σου σκανδαλίζῃ σε, ἔκβαλε αὐτόν | 1 | if your eye may cause you to stumble, tear it out | Here the word **eye** is a metonym for either: (1) desiring to sin by looking at something. Alternate translation: “if you want to do something sinful by looking at something, tear your eye out” or (2) desiring to sin because of what you have looked at. Alternate translation: “if you want to do something sinful because of what you look at, tear your eye out” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
790 | MRK | 9 | 47 | e52s | figs-explicit | μονόφθαλμον εἰσελθεῖν εἰς τὴν Βασιλείαν τοῦ Θεοῦ, ἢ δύο ὀφθαλμοὺς ἔχοντα | 1 | to enter into the kingdom of God with one eye than, having two eyes | This refers to the state of a person’s physical body when he dies. A person does not take his physical body with him into eternity. Alternate translation: “to enter into the kingdom of God after having lived on earth with only one eye than, having lived on earth with two eyes” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
791 | MRK | 9 | 47 | r2gn | figs-activepassive | βληθῆναι εἰς τὴν Γέενναν | 1 | to be thrown into hell | This can be stated in the active form. Alternate translation: “for God to throw you into hell” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
792 | MRK | 9 | 48 | uh4p | figs-explicit | ὅπου ὁ σκώληξ αὐτῶν οὐ τελευτᾷ | 1 | where their worm does not die | The meaning of this statement can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “where worms that eat people there do not die” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
793 | MRK | 9 | 49 | mr5y | figs-activepassive | πᾶς…πυρὶ ἁλισθήσεται | 1 | everyone will be salted with fire | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will salt everyone with fire” or “Just as salt purifies a sacrifice, God will purify everyone by allowing them to suffer” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
794 | MRK | 9 | 49 | ma3s | figs-metaphor | πυρὶ ἁλισθήσεται | 1 | will be salted with fire | Here, **fire** is a metaphor for suffering, and putting salt on people is a metaphor for purifying them. So **will be salted with fire** is a metaphor for being purified through suffering. Alternate translation: “will be made pure in the fire of suffering” or “will suffer in order to be purified as a sacrifice is purified with salt” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
795 | MRK | 9 | 50 | rb7r | ἄναλον γένηται | 1 | may become unsalty | “loses its salty taste” | |
796 | MRK | 9 | 50 | fqb8 | figs-rquestion | ἐν τίνι αὐτὸ ἀρτύσετε? | 1 | with what will you season it? | This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “you cannot make it salty again.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
797 | MRK | 9 | 50 | t76n | αὐτὸ ἀρτύσετε | 1 | will you season it | “will you make it taste salty again” | |
798 | MRK | 9 | 50 | f34y | figs-metaphor | ἔχετε ἐν ἑαυτοῖς ἅλα | 1 | Have salt in yourselves | Jesus speaks of doing good things for one another as if good things were **salt** that people possess. Alternate translation: “Do good to each other, like salt adds flavor to food” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
799 | MRK | 10 | intro | bq25 | 0 | # Mark 10 General Notes<br><br>## Structure and formatting<br><br>Some translations set quotations from the Old Testament farther to the right on the page than the rest of the text. The ULT does this with the quoted material in 10:7-8.<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### Jesus’ teaching about divorce<br><br>The Pharisees wanted to find a way to make Jesus say that it is good to break the law of Moses, so they asked him about divorce. Jesus tells how God originally designed marriage to show that the Pharisees taught wrongly about divorce.<br><br>## Important figures of speech in this chapter<br><br>### Metaphor<br><br>Metaphors are pictures of visible objects that speakers use to explain invisible truths. When Jesus spoke of “the cup which I will drink,” he was speaking of the pain he would suffer on the cross as if it were a bitter, poisonous liquid in a cup.<br><br>## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter<br><br>### Paradox<br><br>A paradox is a true statement that appears to describe something impossible. Jesus uses a paradox when he says, “Whoever wishes to become great among you must be your servant” ([Mark 10:43](../../mrk/10/43.md)). | |||
800 | MRK | 10 | 1 | vf86 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After Jesus and his disciples leave Capernaum, Jesus reminds the Pharisees, as well as his disciples, what God really expects in marriage and divorce. | ||
801 | MRK | 10 | 1 | qq93 | figs-explicit | ἐκεῖθεν ἀναστὰς, ἔρχεται | 1 | having gotten up, he goes from that place | Jesus’ disciples were traveling with him. They were leaving Capernaum. Alternate translation: “getting up, Jesus and his disciples left Capernaum and went” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
802 | MRK | 10 | 1 | j5wa | καὶ πέραν τοῦ Ἰορδάνου | 1 | and the other side of the Jordan River | “and to the land on the other side of the Jordan River” or “and to the area east of the Jordan River” | |
803 | MRK | 10 | 1 | qyp5 | πάλιν ἐδίδασκεν αὐτούς | 1 | he was teaching them again | The word **them** refers to the crowds. | |
804 | MRK | 10 | 1 | vzb4 | εἰώθει | 1 | he had been accustomed to do | “was his custom” or “he usually did” | |
805 | MRK | 10 | 3 | p9nu | τί ὑμῖν ἐνετείλατο Μωϋσῆς? | 1 | What did Moses command you? | Moses gave the law to their ancestors, which they now were also supposed to follow. Alternate translation: “What did Moses command your ancestors about this?” | |
806 | MRK | 10 | 4 | qu28 | βιβλίον ἀποστασίου | 1 | a certificate of divorce | This was a paper saying that the woman was no longer his wife. | |
807 | MRK | 10 | 5 | djt9 | writing-quotations | ὁ δὲ Ἰησοῦς εἶπεν αὐτοῖς…ἔγραψεν ὑμῖν τὴν ἐντολὴν ταύτην | 1 | But Jesus said to them, “Because of your hardness of heart, he wrote this commandment to you | In some languages speakers do not interrupt a quote to say who is speaking. Rather they say who is speaking at the beginning or end of the complete quote. Alternate translation: “But Jesus said to them, ‘He wrote this commandment to you because of your hardness of heart.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-quotations]]) |
808 | MRK | 10 | 5 | jzb2 | πρὸς τὴν σκληροκαρδίαν ὑμῶν, ἔγραψεν ὑμῖν τὴν ἐντολὴν ταύτην | 1 | Because of your hardness of heart, he wrote this commandment to you | Long before this time, Moses wrote this law for the Jews and their descendants because they had hard hearts. The Jews of Jesus’ time also had hard hearts, so Jesus included them by using the words **your** and **you**. Alternate translation: “He wrote this law because your ancestors and you had hard hearts” | |
809 | MRK | 10 | 5 | m73x | figs-metonymy | τὴν σκληροκαρδίαν ὑμῶν | 1 | your hardness of heart | Here, **hearts** is a metonym for a person’s inner being or mind. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
810 | MRK | 10 | 5 | xqzb | figs-metaphor | τὴν σκληροκαρδίαν ὑμῶν | 1 | your hardness of heart | The phrase **hardness of heart** is a metaphor for “stubbornness.” Alternate translation: “your stubbornness” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
811 | MRK | 10 | 6 | m6lj | ἐποίησεν αὐτούς | 1 | He made them | “God made people” | |
812 | MRK | 10 | 7 | k39e | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus continues to quote what God said in the book of Genesis. | ||
813 | MRK | 10 | 7 | xr7h | ἕνεκεν τούτου | 1 | For the sake of this | “Therefore” or “Because of this” | |
814 | MRK | 10 | 8 | rd63 | καὶ ἔσονται οἱ δύο εἰς σάρκα μίαν | 1 | and the two will become one flesh | Jesus finishes quoting what God said in the book of Genesis. | |
815 | MRK | 10 | 8 | p7yc | figs-metaphor | οὐκέτι εἰσὶν δύο, ἀλλὰ μία σάρξ | 1 | they are no longer two, but one flesh | This is a metaphor to illustrate their close union as husband and wife. Alternate translation: “the two people are like one person” or “they are no longer two, but together they are one body” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
816 | MRK | 10 | 9 | ty4e | figs-explicit | ὃ οὖν ὁ Θεὸς συνέζευξεν, ἄνθρωπος μὴ χωριζέτω | 1 | Therefore what God joined together, let man not separate | The phrase **what God joined together** refers to any married couple. Alternate translation: “Therefore since God has joined together husband and wife, let no one tear them apart” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
817 | MRK | 10 | 10 | ufw6 | καὶ εἰς | 1 | And in | “And when Jesus and his disciples were in” | |
818 | MRK | 10 | 10 | c2ya | figs-explicit | εἰς τὴν οἰκίαν | 1 | in the house | Jesus’ disciples were speaking to him privately. Alternate translation: “alone in the house” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
819 | MRK | 10 | 10 | l8fu | περὶ τούτου ἐπηρώτων αὐτόν | 1 | asked him about this | The word **this** refers to the conversation that Jesus had just had with the Pharisees about divorce. | |
820 | MRK | 10 | 11 | i5kp | ὃς ἂν | 1 | Whoever | “Anyone who” | |
821 | MRK | 10 | 11 | vt25 | μοιχᾶται ἐπ’ αὐτήν | 1 | commits adultery against her | Here, **her** refers to the first woman he was married to. | |
822 | MRK | 10 | 12 | sn1m | figs-explicit | μοιχᾶται | 1 | she commits adultery | In this situation she **commits adultery** again her previous husband. Alternate translation: “she commits adultery against him” or “she commits adultery against the first man” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
823 | MRK | 10 | 13 | j3t9 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | When the disciples rebuke the people for bringing their little children to Jesus, he blesses the children and reminds the disciples that people must be as humble as a child to enter the kingdom of God. | ||
824 | MRK | 10 | 13 | zx1f | writing-newevent | καὶ προσέφερον | 1 | And they were bringing | “And people were bringing.” This is the next event in the story. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-newevent]]) |
825 | MRK | 10 | 13 | pk8a | figs-explicit | αὐτῶν ἅψηται | 1 | he might touch them | This means that Jesus would **touch them** with his hands and bless them. Alternate translation: “he might touch them with his hands and bless them” or “he might lay his hands on them and bless them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
826 | MRK | 10 | 13 | w5lm | ἐπετίμησαν αὐτοῖς | 1 | rebuked them | “rebuked the people” | |
827 | MRK | 10 | 14 | lsq4 | ἰδὼν…ὁ Ἰησοῦς | 1 | having seen this, Jesus | The word **this** refers to the disciples rebuking the people who were bringing the children to Jesus. | |
828 | MRK | 10 | 14 | rv7x | ἠγανάκτησεν | 1 | was indignant | “became angry” | |
829 | MRK | 10 | 14 | yi5m | figs-parallelism | ἄφετε τὰ παιδία ἔρχεσθαι πρός με, καὶ μὴ κωλύετε αὐτά | 1 | Permit the little children to come to me, and do not prevent them | These two clauses have similar meanings, repeated for emphasis. In some languages it is more natural to emphasize this in another way. Alternate translation: “Be sure to allow the little children to come to me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]]) |
830 | MRK | 10 | 14 | qj7i | figs-doublenegatives | μὴ κωλύετε | 1 | do not prevent | This is a double negative. In some languages it is more natural to use a positive statement. Alternate translation: “allow” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]]) |
831 | MRK | 10 | 14 | je6w | figs-metaphor | τῶν γὰρ τοιούτων ἐστὶν ἡ Βασιλεία τοῦ Θεοῦ | 1 | for of those such as these is the kingdom of God | The **kingdom** belonging to people represents the kingdom including them. Alternate translation: “the kingdom of God includes people who are like them” or “because only people like them are members of the kingdom of God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
832 | MRK | 10 | 15 | y3a2 | ὃς ἂν μὴ δέξηται τὴν Βασιλείαν τοῦ Θεοῦ ὡς παιδίον, οὐ μὴ εἰσέλθῃ εἰς αὐτήν | 1 | whoever might not receive the kingdom of God as a little child may certainly not enter into it | “if anyone will not receive the kingdom of God as a little child, he will definitely not enter it” | |
833 | MRK | 10 | 15 | a1e7 | figs-simile | ὡς παιδίον | 1 | as a little child | Jesus is comparing how people must receive the kingdom of God to how little children would receive it. Alternate translation: “in the same manner as a child would” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]]) |
834 | MRK | 10 | 15 | h8pt | μὴ δέξηται τὴν Βασιλείαν τοῦ Θεοῦ | 1 | might not receive the kingdom of God | “does not accept God as their king” | |
835 | MRK | 10 | 15 | q3ck | οὐ μὴ εἰσέλθῃ εἰς αὐτήν | 1 | may certainly not enter into it | The word **it** refers to the kingdom of God. | |
836 | MRK | 10 | 16 | jq4f | ἐναγκαλισάμενος αὐτὰ | 1 | having taken them into his arms | “holding the children in his arms” | |
837 | MRK | 10 | 17 | fpp6 | figs-metaphor | ἵνα ζωὴν αἰώνιον κληρονομήσω | 1 | in order that I might inherit everlasting life | Here the man speaks of “receiving” as if it were “inheriting.” This metaphor is used to emphasize the importance of receiving. Also, **inherit** here does not mean that someone has to die first. Alternate translation: “in order to receive eternal life” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
838 | MRK | 10 | 18 | lw1f | figs-rquestion | τί με λέγεις ἀγαθόν? | 1 | Why are you calling me good? | Jesus asks this question to remind the man that no man is **good** the way God is good. Alternate translation: “You do not understand what you are saying when you call me good.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
839 | MRK | 10 | 18 | b5wg | ἀγαθὸς, εἰ μὴ εἷς ὁ Θεός | 1 | is good except God alone | “good. Only God is good” | |
840 | MRK | 10 | 19 | hj3v | μὴ ψευδομαρτυρήσῃς | 1 | do not testify falsely | “do not testify falsely against anyone” or “do not lie about someone in court” | |
841 | MRK | 10 | 21 | syq1 | figs-metaphor | ἕν σε ὑστερεῖ | 1 | One thing you are lacking | “There is one thing you are missing.” Here, **lacking** is a metaphor for needing to do something. Alternate translation: “One thing you need to do” or “There is one thing you have not yet done” or (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
842 | MRK | 10 | 21 | rd85 | figs-metonymy | δὸς τοῖς πτωχοῖς | 1 | give it to the poor | Here the word **it** refers to the things he sells and is a metonym for the money he receives when he sells them. Alternate translation: “give the money to the poor” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
843 | MRK | 10 | 21 | ux1l | figs-nominaladj | τοῖς πτωχοῖς | 1 | to the poor | This refers to **poor** people. Alternate translation: “to poor people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]]) |
844 | MRK | 10 | 21 | iij4 | θησαυρὸν | 1 | treasure | wealth, valuable things | |
845 | MRK | 10 | 22 | v58f | ἔχων κτήματα πολλά | 1 | one having many possessions | “someone who owned many things” | |
846 | MRK | 10 | 23 | k5nk | πῶς δυσκόλως | 1 | How difficult it is | “It is very difficult” | |
847 | MRK | 10 | 24 | z9z1 | ὁ δὲ Ἰησοῦς πάλιν ἀποκριθεὶς λέγει αὐτοῖς | 1 | but again answering, Jesus says to them | “but Jesus said to his disciples again” | |
848 | MRK | 10 | 24 | fh1q | figs-metaphor | τέκνα, πῶς | 1 | Children, how | “My children, how.” Jesus is teaching them as a father would teach his **children**. Alternate translation: “My friends, how” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
849 | MRK | 10 | 24 | jf83 | πῶς δύσκολόν ἐστιν | 1 | how hard it is | “it is very hard” | |
850 | MRK | 10 | 25 | f15k | figs-hyperbole | εὐκοπώτερόν ἐστιν κάμηλον διὰ τρυμαλιᾶς ῥαφίδος διελθεῖν, ἢ πλούσιον εἰς τὴν Βασιλείαν τοῦ Θεοῦ εἰσελθεῖν | 1 | It is easier for a camel to pass through the eye of a needle than for a rich person to enter into the kingdom of God | Jesus uses an exaggeration to emphasize how very difficult it is for **rich** people to get into **the kingdom of God**. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
851 | MRK | 10 | 25 | hl4s | figs-hypo | εὐκοπώτερόν ἐστιν κάμηλον | 1 | It is easier for a camel | This speaks of an impossible situation. If you cannot state this in this way in your language, it can be written as a hypothetical situation. Alternate translation: “It would be easier for a camel” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hypo]]) |
852 | MRK | 10 | 25 | t4y8 | τρυμαλιᾶς ῥαφίδος | 1 | the eye of a needle | “the hole of a needle.” This refers to the small hole in the end of a sewing **needle** that thread passes through. | |
853 | MRK | 10 | 26 | ly6b | οἱ δὲ περισσῶς ἐξεπλήσσοντο | 1 | But they were greatly astonished | “But the disciples were very astonished” | |
854 | MRK | 10 | 26 | q8b7 | figs-rquestion | καὶ τίς δύναται σωθῆναι? | 1 | And who is able to be saved? | This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “If that is so, then no one will be saved!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
855 | MRK | 10 | 27 | a7bi | figs-ellipsis | παρὰ ἀνθρώποις ἀδύνατον, ἀλλ’ οὐ παρὰ Θεῷ | 1 | With men it is impossible, but not with God | The understood information may be supplied. Alternate translation: “It is impossible for people to save themselves, but God can save them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
856 | MRK | 10 | 28 | hcv3 | ἰδοὺ | 1 | Behold | **Behold** is used here to draw attention to the words that come next. | |
857 | MRK | 10 | 28 | cj3f | ἀφήκαμεν πάντα | 1 | have left everything | “have left everything behind” | |
858 | MRK | 10 | 29 | zhx5 | figs-litotes | οὐδείς ἐστιν ὃς ἀφῆκεν | 1 | there is no one who has left | The phrase **there is no one who has left** is a litotes. Jesus uses it to emphasize that every single person who leaves things for Jesus' sake will receive the rewards that he lists in the next verse. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]]) |
859 | MRK | 10 | 29 | m1w3 | ἢ ἀγροὺς | 1 | or lands | “or plots of ground” or “or the land that he owns” | |
860 | MRK | 10 | 29 | hr9y | ἕνεκεν ἐμοῦ | 1 | for my sake | “for my cause” or “for me” | |
861 | MRK | 10 | 29 | pf2g | τοῦ εὐαγγελίου | 1 | for the gospel | “to proclaim the gospel” | |
862 | MRK | 10 | 30 | sjhg | figs-doublenegatives | ἐὰν μὴ λάβῃ | 1 | who may not receive | Jesus finishes a sentence that begins with the words **there is no one who has left** (verse 29). The whole sentence can be stated positively. “everyone who has left house, or brothers, or sisters, or mother, or father, or children, or lands, for my sake, and for the gospel, will receive” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]]) |
863 | MRK | 10 | 30 | heb4 | ἐν τῷ καιρῷ τούτῳ | 1 | in this time | “in this life” or “in this present age” | |
864 | MRK | 10 | 30 | jev2 | ἀδελφοὺς, καὶ ἀδελφὰς, καὶ μητέρας, καὶ τέκνα | 1 | brothers, and sisters, and mothers, and children | Like the list in verse 29, this describes the family in general. The word “fathers” is missing in verse 30, but it does not significantly change the meaning. | |
865 | MRK | 10 | 30 | ae92 | figs-abstractnouns | μετὰ διωγμῶν, καὶ ἐν τῷ αἰῶνι τῷ ἐρχομένῳ, ζωὴν αἰώνιον | 1 | with persecutions, and in the age that is coming, everlasting life | This can be reworded so that the ideas in the abstract noun **persecutions** are expressed with the verb “persecute.” Because the sentence is so long and complicated, “will receive” can be repeated. Alternate translation: “and even though people persecute them, in the world to come, they will receive everlasting life” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]]) |
866 | MRK | 10 | 30 | v8nr | ἐν τῷ αἰῶνι τῷ ἐρχομένῳ | 1 | in the age that is coming | “in the future world” or “in the future” | |
867 | MRK | 10 | 31 | ym7t | figs-metaphor | ἔσονται πρῶτοι ἔσχατοι, καὶ ἔσχατοι πρῶτοι | 1 | who are first will be last, and the last first | Here the words **first** and **last** are opposites of one another. Jesus speaks of being the “important” as being “first” and of being the “unimportant” as being “last.” Alternate translation: “are important will be unimportant, and those who are unimportant will be important” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
868 | MRK | 10 | 31 | xcj1 | figs-nominaladj | ἔσχατοι πρῶτοι | 1 | the last first | The phrase **the last** refers to people who are “last.” Also, the understood verb in this clause may be supplied. Alternate translation: “those who are last, first” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]]) |
869 | MRK | 10 | 31 | mo59 | figs-ellipsis | ἔσχατοι πρῶτοι | 1 | the last first | The understood verb in this clause may be supplied. Alternate translation: “those who are last will be first” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
870 | MRK | 10 | 32 | zc62 | ἦσαν δὲ ἐν τῇ ὁδῷ ἀναβαίνοντες εἰς Ἱεροσόλυμα, καὶ ἦν προάγων αὐτοὺς ὁ Ἰησοῦς | 1 | And they were on the road, going up to Jerusalem, and Jesus was going ahead of them | “And Jesus and his disciples were walking on the road, on the way up to Jerusalem, and Jesus was in front of his disciples” | |
871 | MRK | 10 | 32 | hq7y | οἱ…ἀκολουθοῦντες | 1 | those who are following behind | “those who were following behind them.” Some people were walking behind Jesus and his disciples. | |
872 | MRK | 10 | 33 | pv4w | ἰδοὺ | 1 | Behold | “Look” or “Listen” or “Pay attention to what I am about to tell you” | |
873 | MRK | 10 | 33 | s1hp | figs-explicit | ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου παραδοθήσεται | 1 | the Son of Man will be delivered | Jesus is speaking about himself. This can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “I, the Son of Man, will” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
874 | MRK | 10 | 33 | ha2g | figs-activepassive | ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου παραδοθήσεται | 1 | the Son of Man will be delivered | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “someone will deliver the Son of Man” or “they will hand the Son of Man over” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
875 | MRK | 10 | 33 | zhf1 | κατακρινοῦσιν | 1 | they will condemn | The word **they** refers to the chief priests and the scribes. | |
876 | MRK | 10 | 33 | ils2 | παραδώσουσιν αὐτὸν τοῖς ἔθνεσιν | 1 | deliver him to the Gentiles | “put him under the control of the Gentiles” | |
877 | MRK | 10 | 34 | ccd3 | ἐμπαίξουσιν | 1 | they will mock | “people will mock” | |
878 | MRK | 10 | 34 | xv2g | figs-explicit | ἀναστήσεται | 1 | he will rise | This refers to rising from the dead. Alternate translation: “he will rise from being dead” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
879 | MRK | 10 | 35 | li9k | figs-exclusive | θέλομεν…αἰτήσωμέν…ἡμῖν | 1 | we desire … for us … we may ask | The words **we** and **us** refer only to James and John. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]]) |
880 | MRK | 10 | 37 | bb98 | figs-metonymy | ἐν τῇ δόξῃ σου | 1 | in your glory | “when you are glorified.” The phrase **in your glory** refers to when Jesus is glorified and rules over his kingdom. Alternate translation: “when you rule in your kingdom” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
881 | MRK | 10 | 38 | v1bf | οὐκ οἴδατε | 1 | You do not know | “You do not understand” | |
882 | MRK | 10 | 38 | yvu8 | figs-metaphor | πιεῖν τὸ ποτήριον ὃ ἐγὼ πίνω | 1 | to drink the cup which I am drinking | Here, **cup** refers to what Jesus must suffer. Suffering is often referred to as drinking from a cup. Alternate translation: “drink the cup of suffering that I will drink” or “drink from the cup of suffering that I will drink from” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
883 | MRK | 10 | 38 | pd7l | figs-metaphor | τὸ βάπτισμα ὃ ἐγὼ βαπτίζομαι βαπτισθῆναι | 1 | to be baptized with the baptism with which I am being baptized | Here, **baptism** and **being baptized** represent suffering. Just as water covers a person during baptism, suffering will overwhelm Jesus. Alternate translation: “to endure the baptism of suffering which I will suffer” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
884 | MRK | 10 | 39 | r3pm | figs-ellipsis | δυνάμεθα | 1 | We are able | They respond this way, meaning that they **are able** to drink the same cup and endure the same baptism. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
885 | MRK | 10 | 39 | hc1g | πίεσθε | 1 | you will drink | “you will drink as well” | |
886 | MRK | 10 | 40 | ig8f | τὸ δὲ καθίσαι ἐκ δεξιῶν μου ἢ ἐξ εὐωνύμων, οὐκ ἔστιν ἐμὸν δοῦναι | 1 | But to sit at my right hand or at my left hand is not mine to give | “But I am not the one who allows people to sit at my right hand or my left hand” | |
887 | MRK | 10 | 40 | pdc1 | ἀλλ’ οἷς ἡτοίμασται | 1 | but it is for those for whom it has been prepared | “but those places are for those for whom they have been prepared.” The word **it** refers to the places to his right hand and to his left hand. | |
888 | MRK | 10 | 40 | eu9v | figs-activepassive | ἡτοίμασται | 1 | it has been prepared | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God has prepared it” or “God has prepared them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
889 | MRK | 10 | 41 | ad19 | ἀκούσαντες, | 1 | When heard about this | The word **this** refers to James and John asking to sit at Jesus’ right and left hands. | |
890 | MRK | 10 | 42 | sbk8 | προσκαλεσάμενος αὐτοὺς ὁ Ἰησοῦς | 1 | having summoned them, Jesus | “after Jesus called his disciples, he” | |
891 | MRK | 10 | 42 | sfs9 | figs-activepassive | οἱ δοκοῦντες ἄρχειν τῶν ἐθνῶν | 1 | that those who are considered rulers of the Gentiles | This can be stated in active form. This could mean: (1) people in general consider these people the rulers of the Gentiles. Alternate translation: “that those whom people consider to be the rulers of the Gentiles” or (2) the Gentiles consider these people their rulers. Alternate translation: “that those whom the Gentiles think of as their rulers” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
892 | MRK | 10 | 42 | hme7 | κατακυριεύουσιν | 1 | lord it over | have control or power over | |
893 | MRK | 10 | 42 | zfr3 | κατεξουσιάζουσιν | 1 | exercise authority over | “flaunt their authority over.” This means that they show or use their authority in an overbearing way. | |
894 | MRK | 10 | 43 | zfz6 | figs-explicit | οὐχ οὕτως δέ ἐστιν ἐν ὑμῖν | 1 | But it is not this way among you | This refers back to the previous verse about the Gentile rulers. This can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “But do not be like them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
895 | MRK | 10 | 43 | fc3m | μέγας γενέσθαι | 1 | to become great | “to be highly respected” | |
896 | MRK | 10 | 44 | e7sn | figs-metaphor | εἶναι πρῶτος | 1 | to be first | This is a metaphor for being the most important. Alternate translation: “to be the most important” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
897 | MRK | 10 | 45 | a3fr | figs-activepassive | καὶ γὰρ ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου οὐκ ἦλθεν διακονηθῆναι | 1 | For even the Son of Man did not come to be served | This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “For even the Son of Man did not come to have people serve him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
898 | MRK | 10 | 45 | rik1 | διακονηθῆναι, ἀλλὰ διακονῆσαι | 1 | to be served, but to serve | “to be served by people, but to serve people” | |
899 | MRK | 10 | 45 | d9jd | ἀντὶ πολλῶν | 1 | in exchange for many | “in the place of many people” | |
900 | MRK | 10 | 46 | n4i3 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | As Jesus and his disciples continue walking toward Jerusalem, Jesus heals blind Bartimaeus, who then walks with them. | ||
901 | MRK | 10 | 46 | bq3j | translate-names | ὁ υἱὸς Τιμαίου, Βαρτιμαῖος, τυφλὸς προσαίτης | 1 | Bartimaeus, a blind beggar, son of Timaeus | “a blind beggar named Bartimaeus, the son of Timaeus.” **Bartimaeus** is the name of a man. **Timaeus** is his father’s name. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
902 | MRK | 10 | 47 | ynr7 | figs-ellipsis | ἀκούσας ὅτι Ἰησοῦς…ἐστιν | 1 | having heard that it was Jesus | Bartimaeus **heard** people saying **that it was Jesus**. Alternate translation: “when he heard people saying that it was Jesus” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
903 | MRK | 10 | 47 | vwz9 | figs-explicit | Υἱὲ Δαυεὶδ | 1 | Son of David | Jesus is called the Son of David because he is a descendant of King David. Alternate translation: “You who are the Messiah descended from King David” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
904 | MRK | 10 | 48 | ca5u | ἐπετίμων…πολλοὶ | 1 | many were rebuking | “many people rebuked” | |
905 | MRK | 10 | 48 | m32u | πολλῷ μᾶλλον | 1 | much more | “even more” | |
906 | MRK | 10 | 49 | t5ch | figs-quotations | εἶπεν, φωνήσατε αὐτόν | 1 | said, “Call him.” | This can be translated as an indirect quote. Alternate translation: “commanded others to call him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]]) |
907 | MRK | 10 | 49 | ac7h | φωνοῦσι | 1 | they call | The word **they** refers to the crowd. | |
908 | MRK | 10 | 49 | jvr1 | θάρσει | 1 | Take courage! | “Have courage” or “Do not be afraid” | |
909 | MRK | 10 | 49 | gnb9 | φωνεῖ σε | 1 | He is calling you | “Jesus is calling for you” | |
910 | MRK | 10 | 50 | z6ec | ἀναπηδήσας | 1 | having sprung up | “having jumped up” | |
911 | MRK | 10 | 51 | i5an | ἀποκριθεὶς αὐτῷ | 1 | answering him | “answering the blind man” | |
912 | MRK | 10 | 51 | dap1 | ἀναβλέψω | 1 | I might receive my sight | “I would be able to see” | |
913 | MRK | 10 | 52 | s5d2 | figs-explicit | ἡ πίστις σου σέσωκέν σε | 1 | Your faith has healed you | This phrase is written this way to place emphasis on the man’s **faith**. Jesus heals the man because he believes that Jesus can heal him. This can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “I am healing you because you believed in me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
914 | MRK | 10 | 52 | ub7w | ἠκολούθει αὐτῷ | 1 | he was following him | “he followed Jesus” | |
915 | MRK | 11 | intro | xg3t | 0 | # Mark 11 General Notes<br><br>## Structure and formatting<br><br>Some translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 11:9-10, 17, which are words from the Old Testament.<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### The donkey and the colt<br><br>Jesus rode into Jerusalem on an animal. In this way he was like a king who came into a city after he had won an important battle. Also, the kings of Israel in the Old Testament rode on a donkeys. Other kings rode on horses. So Jesus was showing that he was the king of Israel and that he was not like other kings.<br><br>Matthew, Mark, Luke, and John all wrote about this event. Matthew and Mark wrote that the disciples brought Jesus a donkey. John wrote that Jesus found a donkey. Luke wrote that they brought him a colt. Only Matthew wrote that there were both a donkey had a colt. No one knows for sure whether Jesus rode the donkey or the colt. It is best to translate each of these accounts as it appears in the ULT without trying to make them all say exactly the same thing. (See: [Matthew 21:1-7](../mat/21/01.md) and [Mark 11:1-7](../mrk/11/01.md) and [Luke 19:29-36](../luk/19/29.md) and [John 12:14-15](../jhn/12/14.md)) | |||
916 | MRK | 11 | 1 | ch4j | καὶ ὅτε ἐγγίζουσιν εἰς Ἱεροσόλυμα, εἰς Βηθφαγὴ καὶ Βηθανίαν πρὸς τὸ Ὄρος τῶν Ἐλαιῶν | 1 | And when they come to Jerusalem, to Bethphage and Bethany, to the Mount of Olives | “And when Jesus and his disciples came near to Jerusalem, they came to Bethphage and Bethany near the Mount of Olives” They had come to **Bethphage and Bethany** in the vicinity of **Jerusalem**. | |
917 | MRK | 11 | 1 | g1fy | translate-names | Βηθφαγὴ | 1 | Bethphage | This is the name of a village. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
918 | MRK | 11 | 2 | bi22 | τὴν κατέναντι ὑμῶν | 1 | opposite us | “ahead of us” | |
919 | MRK | 11 | 2 | r41g | πῶλον | 1 | a colt | This refers to a young donkey that is large enough to carry a man. | |
920 | MRK | 11 | 2 | yw78 | figs-activepassive | ἐφ’ ὃν οὐδεὶς ἀνθρώπων οὔπω ἐκάθισεν | 1 | on which no man has yet sat | This can be written in active form. Alternate translation: “that no one has ever ridden” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
921 | MRK | 11 | 3 | xw55 | figs-explicit | τί ποιεῖτε τοῦτο? | 1 | Why are you doing this? | It can be written clearly what the word **this** refers to. Alternate translation: “Why are you untying and taking the colt?” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
922 | MRK | 11 | 3 | k7fd | αὐτοῦ χρείαν ἔχει | 1 | has need of it | “needs it” | |
923 | MRK | 11 | 3 | yj5y | figs-explicit | εὐθὺς αὐτὸν ἀποστέλλει πάλιν ὧδε | 1 | immediately he sends it back here | Jesus will send it back promptly when he is finished using it. Alternate translation: “will immediately send it back when he no longer needs it” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
924 | MRK | 11 | 4 | y381 | ἀπῆλθον | 1 | they went away | “the two disciples went away” | |
925 | MRK | 11 | 4 | i2ml | πῶλον | 1 | a colt | This refers to a young donkey that is large enough to carry a man. See how you translated this in [Mark 11:2](../11/02.md). | |
926 | MRK | 11 | 6 | j39z | οἱ…εἶπον | 1 | they spoke | “they responded” | |
927 | MRK | 11 | 6 | ij7y | καθὼς εἶπεν ὁ Ἰησοῦς | 1 | just as Jesus told them | “just as Jesus had told them to respond.” This refers to how **Jesus** had **told them** to respond to people’s questions about taking the colt. | |
928 | MRK | 11 | 6 | m8pm | figs-idiom | ἀφῆκαν αὐτούς | 1 | they gave them permission | This means that they allowed them to continue doing what they were doing. Alternate translation: “they let them take the donkey with them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
929 | MRK | 11 | 7 | ice6 | ἐπιβάλλουσιν αὐτῷ τὰ ἱμάτια αὐτῶν, καὶ ἐκάθισεν ἐπ’ αὐτόν | 1 | throw their cloaks on it, and he sat on it | “laid their cloaks on its back so Jesus could ride it.” It is easier to ride a colt or a horse when there is a blanket or something similar on its back. In this case, the disciples threw **their cloaks** on it. | |
930 | MRK | 11 | 7 | k9g7 | τὰ ἱμάτια | 1 | cloaks | “coats” or “robes” | |
931 | MRK | 11 | 8 | t8hy | figs-explicit | πολλοὶ τὰ ἱμάτια αὐτῶν ἔστρωσαν εἰς τὴν ὁδόν | 1 | many spread their cloaks on the road | It was a tradition to lay garments on **the road** in front of important people to honor them. This can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “many people spread their garments on the road to honor him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
932 | MRK | 11 | 8 | nx3n | figs-explicit | ἄλλοι δὲ στιβάδας κόψαντες ἐκ τῶν ἀγρῶν | 1 | and others, branches having been cut from the fields | It was a tradition to lay palm **branches** on the road in front of an important people to honor them. Alternate translation: “and others spread branches on the road that they had cut from the fields, also to honor him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
933 | MRK | 11 | 9 | ye41 | οἱ ἀκολουθοῦντες | 1 | those following | “those who followed Jesus” | |
934 | MRK | 11 | 9 | d8se | translate-transliterate | ὡσαννά | 1 | Hosanna | This word means “save us,” but people also shouted it joyfully when they wanted to praise God. You can translate it according to how it was used, or you can write **Hosanna** using your language’s way of spelling that word. Alternate translation: “Praise God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]]) |
935 | MRK | 11 | 9 | x1bz | figs-explicit | εὐλογημένος ὁ ἐρχόμενος | 1 | Blessed is the one who comes | This is referring to Jesus. This can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “Blessed are you, the one” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
936 | MRK | 11 | 9 | e2p6 | figs-metonymy | ἐν ὀνόματι Κυρίου | 1 | in the name of the Lord | This is a metonym for the Lord’s authority. Alternate translation: “with the authority of the Lord” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
937 | MRK | 11 | 9 | el81 | εὐλογημένος | 1 | Blessed is | “May God bless” | |
938 | MRK | 11 | 10 | a6b4 | figs-explicit | εὐλογημένη ἡ ἐρχομένη βασιλεία τοῦ πατρὸς ἡμῶν, Δαυείδ | 1 | Blessed is the coming kingdom of our father David | “Blessed is our father David’s coming kingdom.” This refers to Jesus **coming** and ruling as king. Alternate translation: “Blessed be the coming of your kingdom” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
939 | MRK | 11 | 10 | kkfo | figs-activepassive | εὐλογημένη ἡ ἐρχομένη βασιλεία τοῦ πατρὸς ἡμῶν, Δαυείδ | 1 | Blessed is the coming kingdom of our father David | The word **blessed** can be translated as an active verb. Alternate translation: “May God bless you as you rule your coming kingdom” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
940 | MRK | 11 | 10 | diq8 | figs-metonymy | τοῦ πατρὸς ἡμῶν, Δαυείδ | 1 | of our father David | Here David’s descendant who will rule is referred to as **David** himself. Alternate translation: “of the greatest descendant of our father David” or “that David’s greatest descendant will rule” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
941 | MRK | 11 | 10 | b1si | ὡσαννὰ ἐν τοῖς ὑψίστοις | 1 | Hosanna in the highest | This could mean: (1) “Praise God who is in heaven” or (2) “Let those who are in heaven shout ‘Hosanna’.” | |
942 | MRK | 11 | 10 | vqm2 | figs-metaphor | τοῖς ὑψίστοις | 1 | the highest | Here heaven is spoken of as **the highest**. Alternate translation: “the highest heaven” or “heaven” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
943 | MRK | 11 | 11 | mz8r | ὀψίας ἤδη οὔσης τῆς ὥρας | 1 | the hour already being late | “because it was already late in the day” | |
944 | MRK | 11 | 11 | t5nv | ἐξῆλθεν εἰς Βηθανίαν μετὰ τῶν δώδεκα | 1 | he went out to Bethany with the Twelve | “he and his twelve disciples left Jerusalem and went to Bethany” | |
945 | MRK | 11 | 12 | zr8n | ἐξελθόντων αὐτῶν ἀπὸ Βηθανίας | 1 | when they had returned from Bethany | “while they were going back to Jerusalem from Bethany” | |
946 | MRK | 11 | 13 | y447 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | This happens while Jesus and his disciples are walking to Jerusalem. | ||
947 | MRK | 11 | 13 | yg5n | εἰ ἄρα τι εὑρήσει ἐν αὐτῇ | 1 | if perhaps he could find anything on it | “looking to see if there was any fruit on it” | |
948 | MRK | 11 | 13 | j6cq | figs-litotes | οὐδὲν εὗρεν εἰ μὴ φύλλα | 1 | he found nothing except leaves | Mark is using a negative expressions to emphasize that there were only leaves on the tree. Alternate translation: “he found only leaves on the tree” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]]) |
949 | MRK | 11 | 13 | vy09 | figs-explicit | οὐδὲν εὗρεν εἰ μὴ φύλλα | 1 | he found nothing except leaves | This means that he did not find any figs. Alternate translation: “he did not find any figs at all on the tree” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
950 | MRK | 11 | 13 | g76z | ὁ…καιρὸς | 1 | the season | “the time of year” | |
951 | MRK | 11 | 14 | u3bk | figs-apostrophe | εἶπεν αὐτῇ, μηκέτι εἰς τὸν αἰῶνα, ἐκ σοῦ μηδεὶς καρπὸν φάγοι | 1 | he said to it, “No one will ever eat fruit from you again.” | Jesus speaks to the fig tree and curses it. He speaks to it so that his disciples hear him. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-apostrophe]]) |
952 | MRK | 11 | 14 | b362 | εἶπεν αὐτῇ | 1 | he said to it | “he spoke to the tree” | |
953 | MRK | 11 | 14 | ij5h | ἤκουον οἱ μαθηταὶ αὐτοῦ | 1 | his disciples heard it | The word **it** refers to Jesus speaking to the fig tree. | |
954 | MRK | 11 | 15 | hj7z | ἔρχονται | 1 | coming | “Jesus and his disciples came” | |
955 | MRK | 11 | 15 | md5l | figs-explicit | ἤρξατο ἐκβάλλειν τοὺς πωλοῦντας καὶ τοὺς ἀγοράζοντας ἐν τῷ ἱερῷ | 1 | he began to cast out those selling and those buying in the temple | Jesus is forcing these people out of **the temple**. This can be written clearly. Alternate translation: “he began to drive the sellers and buyers out of the temple” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
956 | MRK | 11 | 15 | s4m2 | τοὺς πωλοῦντας καὶ τοὺς ἀγοράζοντας | 1 | those selling and those buying | “the people who were buying and selling” | |
957 | MRK | 11 | 17 | ve56 | 0 | General Information: | God had said earlier in his word, through the prophet Isaiah, that his temple would be a house of prayer for all the nations. | ||
958 | MRK | 11 | 17 | xrz2 | figs-rquestion | οὐ γέγραπται, ὅτι ὁ οἶκός μου, οἶκος προσευχῆς κληθήσεται πᾶσιν τοῖς ἔθνεσιν? | 1 | Is it not written, ‘My house will be called a house of prayer for all the nations’? | Jesus is rebuking the Jewish leaders for their misuse of the temple. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “It is written in the scriptures that God said, ‘I want my house to be called a house where people from all nations may pray.’” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
959 | MRK | 11 | 17 | dpt1 | figs-metaphor | ὑμεῖς δὲ ἐποιήσατε αὐτὸν σπήλαιον λῃστῶν | 1 | But you have made it a den of robbers | Jesus compares the people to **robbers** and the temple to a robbers’ **den**. Alternate translation: “But you are like robbers who have made my house into a robbers’ den” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
960 | MRK | 11 | 17 | qc6k | σπήλαιον λῃστῶν | 1 | a den of robbers | “a cave where robbers hide” | |
961 | MRK | 11 | 18 | k6dv | ἐζήτουν πῶς | 1 | they were seeking a way | “they were looking for a way” | |
962 | MRK | 11 | 19 | h4hg | ὅταν ὀψὲ ἐγένετο | 1 | when evening came | “in the evening” | |
963 | MRK | 11 | 19 | y7la | ἐξεπορεύοντο ἔξω τῆς πόλεως | 1 | they were departing from the city | “Jesus and his disciples left the city” | |
964 | MRK | 11 | 20 | m27r | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus uses the example of the fig tree to remind the disciples to have faith in God. | ||
965 | MRK | 11 | 20 | b56h | παραπορευόμενοι | 1 | passing by | “walking along the road” | |
966 | MRK | 11 | 20 | s8ki | figs-explicit | τὴν συκῆν ἐξηραμμένην ἐκ ῥιζῶν | 1 | the fig tree had been withered from its roots | Translate this statement to clarify that the **tree** died. Alternate translation: “the fig tree had withered away down to its roots and died” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
967 | MRK | 11 | 20 | a83v | ἐξηραμμένην | 1 | had been withered | “had dried up” | |
968 | MRK | 11 | 21 | jt3h | figs-explicit | ἀναμνησθεὶς ὁ Πέτρος | 1 | having remembered, Peter | It may be helpful to state what **Peter** **remembered**. Alternate translation: “Peter, remembering what Jesus had said to the fig tree,” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
969 | MRK | 11 | 22 | ry5v | ἀποκριθεὶς ὁ Ἰησοῦς λέγει αὐτοῖς | 1 | answering, Jesus says to them | “Jesus replied to his disciples” | |
970 | MRK | 11 | 23 | sy61 | ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν | 1 | Truly I say to you | “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next. | |
971 | MRK | 11 | 23 | c3cj | ὃς ἂν εἴπῃ | 1 | whoever might say | “if anyone says” | |
972 | MRK | 11 | 23 | y76p | figs-metonymy | μὴ διακριθῇ ἐν τῇ καρδίᾳ αὐτοῦ, ἀλλὰ πιστεύῃ | 1 | may not doubt in his heart, but may believe | Here, **heart** is a metonym for a person’s mind or inner being. Alternate translation: “if he truly believes in his heart” or “if he does not doubt but believes” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
973 | MRK | 11 | 23 | fzp5 | ἔσται αὐτῷ | 1 | it will be for him | “God will make it happen” | |
974 | MRK | 11 | 24 | pn9x | grammar-connect-words-phrases | διὰ τοῦτο λέγω ὑμῖν | 1 | Because of this, I say to you | “So I tell you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/grammar-connect-words-phrases]]) |
975 | MRK | 11 | 24 | tu5z | figs-explicit | ἔσται ὑμῖν | 1 | it will be yours | It is understood that this will happen because God will provide what you ask for. This can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “God will give it to you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
976 | MRK | 11 | 25 | m7xi | ὅταν στήκετε προσευχόμενοι | 1 | when you stand praying | It is common in Hebrew culture to **stand** when **praying** to God. Alternate translation: “when you pray” | |
977 | MRK | 11 | 25 | f6ex | εἴ τι ἔχετε κατά τινος | 1 | if you have something against anyone | “whatever grudge you have against anyone.” Here the word **something** refers to any grudge you hold **against** someone for sinning against you or any anger you have against someone. | |
978 | MRK | 11 | 27 | n3ei | 0 | Connecting Statement: | The next day when Jesus returns to temple, he gives the chief priests, scribes, and elders an answer to their question about his casting the money changers out of the temple area, by asking them another question, which they were not willing to answer. | ||
979 | MRK | 11 | 27 | s2ac | ἔρχονται…εἰς | 1 | they come to | “Jesus and his disciples came to” | |
980 | MRK | 11 | 27 | alh5 | ἐν τῷ ἱερῷ περιπατοῦντος αὐτοῦ | 1 | as he is walking around in the temple | This means that Jesus was walking around inside of the temple courtyard; he was not walking into the temple. | |
981 | MRK | 11 | 28 | r3ik | ἔλεγον αὐτῷ | 1 | they were saying to him | The word **they** refers to the chief priests, the scribes, and the elders. | |
982 | MRK | 11 | 28 | se9b | figs-parallelism | ἐν ποίᾳ ἐξουσίᾳ ταῦτα ποιεῖς? ἢ, τίς σοι ἔδωκεν τὴν ἐξουσίαν ταύτην, ἵνα ταῦτα ποιῇς? | 1 | By what authority do you do these things, and who gave you this authority, so that you might do them? | This could mean: (1) Both of these questions have the same meaning and are asked together to strongly question Jesus’ authority and so can be combined. Alternate translation: “Who gave you authority to do these things?” (2) These are two separate questions, the first asking about the nature of the authority and the second about who gave it to him. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]]) |
983 | MRK | 11 | 28 | p5u3 | figs-explicit | ταῦτα | 1 | these things | The words **these things** refer to Jesus turning over the sellers’ tables in the temple and speaking against what the chief priests and scribes taught. Alternate translation: “things like those you did here yesterday” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
984 | MRK | 11 | 30 | jj91 | τὸ βάπτισμα τὸ Ἰωάννου | 1 | The baptism of John | “The baptism that John performed” | |
985 | MRK | 11 | 30 | fr1b | ἐξ οὐρανοῦ ἦν ἢ ἐξ ἀνθρώπων | 1 | was it from heaven or from men | “was it authorized by heaven or by men” | |
986 | MRK | 11 | 30 | sh7b | figs-metonymy | ἐξ οὐρανοῦ | 1 | from heaven | Here, **heaven** refers to God. Alternate translation: “from God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
987 | MRK | 11 | 30 | i5is | ἐξ ἀνθρώπων | 1 | from men | “from people” | |
988 | MRK | 11 | 31 | s9vv | figs-ellipsis | ἐὰν εἴπωμεν, ἐξ οὐρανοῦ | 1 | If we would say, ‘From heaven,’ | This refers to the source of the baptism of John. Alternate translation: “If we say, ‘It was from heaven,’” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
989 | MRK | 11 | 31 | nu1m | figs-metonymy | ἐξ οὐρανοῦ | 1 | From heaven | Here, **heaven** refers to God. See how you translated this in [Mark 11:30](../11/30.md). Alternate translation: “From God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
990 | MRK | 11 | 31 | t9er | οὐκ ἐπιστεύσατε αὐτῷ | 1 | did you not believe him | The word **him** refers to John the Baptist. | |
991 | MRK | 11 | 32 | aus1 | figs-ellipsis | ἀλλὰ εἴπωμεν, ἐξ ἀνθρώπων | 1 | But we might say, ‘From men,’ | This refers to the source of the baptism of John. Alternate translation: “But if we say, ‘It was from men,’” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
992 | MRK | 11 | 32 | v2gs | ἐξ ἀνθρώπων | 1 | From men | “From people” | |
993 | MRK | 11 | 32 | b5qb | figs-explicit | ἀλλὰ εἴπωμεν, ἐξ ἀνθρώπων? | 1 | But we might say, ‘From men,’… | The religious leaders imply that they will suffer from the people if they give this answer. Alternate translation: “But we do not want to say that it was from men or the crowd may attack us.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
994 | MRK | 11 | 32 | z93u | figs-ellipsis | ἀλλὰ εἴπωμεν, ἐξ ἀνθρώπων? | 1 | But we might say, ‘From men,’… | The religious leaders do not finish their statement, since they all understood what would happen if they said John's baptism was not from God. Alternate translation: “But if we say, ‘From men,’ that would not be good.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
995 | MRK | 11 | 32 | z998 | figs-explicit | ἐφοβοῦντο τὸν ὄχλον | 1 | They were afraid of the crowd | The author, Mark, explains why the religious leaders did not want to say that John’s baptism was from men. This can be stated clearly. “They said this to each other because they were afraid of the people” or “They did not want to say that John’s baptism was from men because they were afraid of the people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
996 | MRK | 11 | 33 | us4a | figs-ellipsis | οὐκ οἴδαμεν | 1 | We do not know | This refers to the baptism of John. This understood information may be supplied. Alternate translation: “We do not know where the baptism of John came from” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
997 | MRK | 12 | intro | ne55 | 0 | # Mark 12 General Notes<br><br>## Structure and formatting<br><br>Some translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 12:10-11, 36, which are words from the Old Testament.<br><br>## Important figures of speech in this chapter<br><br>### Hypothetical Situations<br><br>Hypothetical situations are situations that have not actually happened. People describe these situations so they learn what their hearers think is good and bad or right and wrong. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hypo]]) | |||
998 | MRK | 12 | 1 | w2hb | figs-parables | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus speaks this parable against the chief priests, the scribes, and the elders. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]]) | |
999 | MRK | 12 | 1 | qa93 | καὶ ἤρξατο αὐτοῖς ἐν παραβολαῖς λαλεῖν | 1 | Then Jesus began to speak to them in parables | The word **them** here refers to the chief priests, the scribes, and the elders to whom Jesus had been talking in the previous chapter. | |
1000 | MRK | 12 | 1 | qap8 | περιέθηκεν φραγμὸν | 1 | put a hedge around it | He put a barrier around the vineyard. It could have been a row of shrubs, a fence, or a stone wall. | |
1001 | MRK | 12 | 1 | ns9e | figs-explicit | ὤρυξεν ὑπολήνιον | 1 | dug a pit for a winepress | This means that he carved a pit on the rock, which would be the bottom part of the winepress used for collecting the squeezed grape juice. Alternate translation: “carved a pit into rock for the winepress” or “he made a vat to collect the juice from the winepress” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1002 | MRK | 12 | 1 | l2i2 | ἐξέδετο αὐτὸν γεωργοῖς | 1 | leased the vineyard to vine growers | The owner still owned the vineyard, but he allowed the vine growers to take care of it. When the grapes became ripe, they were to give some of them to the owner and keep the rest. | |
1003 | MRK | 12 | 2 | s83v | figs-explicit | τῷ καιρῷ | 1 | at the season | This refers to the time of harvest. This can be made clear. Alternate translation: “when the time came to harvest the grapes” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1004 | MRK | 12 | 3 | vz7k | καὶ λαβόντες αὐτὸν | 1 | But having seized him | “But after the vine growers grabbed the slave” | |
1005 | MRK | 12 | 3 | c321 | figs-explicit | κενόν | 1 | with nothing | This means that they did not give him any of the fruit. Alternate translation: “without any grapes” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1006 | MRK | 12 | 4 | f3f4 | ἀπέστειλεν πρὸς αὐτοὺς | 1 | he sent to them | “the owner of the vineyard sent to the vine growers” | |
1007 | MRK | 12 | 4 | w1ge | figs-explicit | κἀκεῖνον ἐκεφαλίωσαν | 1 | and that one, they wounded in the head | This can be written more clearly. Alternate translation: “and they beat that one on the head, and they hurt him terribly” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1008 | MRK | 12 | 5 | l1yw | figs-ellipsis | ἄλλον…κἀκεῖνον ἀπέκτειναν; καὶ πολλοὺς ἄλλους | 1 | another, and that one they killed, and many others | These phrases refer to other slaves. Alternate translation: “yet another slave, and they killed him, and many other slaves” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1009 | MRK | 12 | 6 | z5hz | figs-explicit | υἱὸν ἀγαπητόν | 1 | a beloved son | It is implied that this is the owner’s **son**. Alternate translation: “his beloved son” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1010 | MRK | 12 | 7 | m63e | figs-explicit | ὁ κληρονόμος | 1 | the heir | This is the owner’s **heir**, who would inherit the vineyard after his father died. Alternate translation: “the owner’s heir” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1011 | MRK | 12 | 7 | s5dc | figs-synecdoche | ἡ κληρονομία | 1 | the inheritance | The tenants are referring to the vineyard as **the inheritance**. Alternate translation: “this vineyard” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
1012 | MRK | 12 | 8 | gx6l | λαβόντες | 1 | having seized him | “after the vine growers seized the son” | |
1013 | MRK | 12 | 9 | r4md | figs-rquestion | τί οὖν ποιήσει ὁ κύριος τοῦ ἀμπελῶνος? | 1 | Therefore, what will the lord of the vineyard do? | Jesus asks a question and then gives the answer to teach the people. The question may be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “So I will tell you what the owner of the vineyard will do.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1014 | MRK | 12 | 9 | rde6 | grammar-connect-words-phrases | οὖν | 1 | Therefore | Jesus has finished telling the parable and is now asking the people what they think will happen next. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/grammar-connect-words-phrases]]) |
1015 | MRK | 12 | 9 | g4ce | ἀπολέσει | 1 | destroy | kill | |
1016 | MRK | 12 | 9 | mc5y | figs-explicit | δώσει τὸν ἀμπελῶνα ἄλλοις | 1 | will give the vineyard to others | The word **others** refers to other vine growers who will care for the vineyard. Alternate translation: “he will give the vineyard to other vine growers to care for it” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1017 | MRK | 12 | 10 | v6ta | 0 | General Information: | This scripture was written long before in God’s word. | ||
1018 | MRK | 12 | 10 | xj9j | figs-rquestion | οὐδὲ τὴν Γραφὴν ταύτην ἀνέγνωτε: | 1 | And have you not read this scripture? | Jesus reminds the people of a **scripture** passage. He uses a rhetorical question here to rebuke them. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “And surely you have read this scripture.” or “And you should remember this scripture.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1019 | MRK | 12 | 10 | jpa3 | ἐγενήθη εἰς κεφαλὴν γωνίας | 1 | has become the head of the corner | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the Lord made into the cornerstone” | |
1020 | MRK | 12 | 11 | r8z8 | παρὰ Κυρίου ἐγένετο αὕτη | 1 | This came from the Lord | “The Lord has done this” | |
1021 | MRK | 12 | 11 | k5w6 | figs-metaphor | ἔστιν θαυμαστὴ ἐν ὀφθαλμοῖς ἡμῶν | 1 | it is marvelous in our eyes | Here, **in our eyes** stands for seeing, which is a metaphor for the people’s opinion. Alternate translation: “we have seen it and think that it is marvelous” or “we think that it is wonderful” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1022 | MRK | 12 | 12 | b1vz | ἐζήτουν αὐτὸν κρατῆσαι | 1 | they were seeking to seize him | Here, **they** refers to the chief priests, scribes, and elders. This group may be referred to as “the Jewish leaders.” | |
1023 | MRK | 12 | 12 | sl74 | ἐζήτουν | 1 | they were seeking | “they wanted” | |
1024 | MRK | 12 | 12 | lx62 | figs-explicit | καὶ ἐφοβήθησαν τὸν ὄχλον | 1 | but they feared the crowd | They were afraid of what **the crowd** would do to them if they arrested Jesus. This can be made clear. Alternate translation: “but they feared what the crowd would do if they arrested him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1025 | MRK | 12 | 12 | v9wb | πρὸς αὐτοὺς | 1 | against them | “to accuse them” | |
1026 | MRK | 12 | 13 | s1hb | 0 | Connecting Statement: | In an effort to trap Jesus, some of the Pharisees and Herodians, and then the Sadducees, come to Jesus with questions. | ||
1027 | MRK | 12 | 13 | z2sf | καὶ ἀποστέλλουσιν | 1 | And they send | “Then the Jewish leaders sent” | |
1028 | MRK | 12 | 13 | pj3c | τῶν Ἡρῳδιανῶν | 1 | the Herodians | This was the name of an informal political party that supported Herod Antipas. | |
1029 | MRK | 12 | 13 | kuy5 | figs-metaphor | ἵνα αὐτὸν ἀγρεύσωσιν | 1 | in order to trap him | Here the author describes tricking Jesus as “trapping him.” Alternate translation: “to trick him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1030 | MRK | 12 | 14 | dh3d | λέγουσιν | 1 | they say | Here, **they** refers to those sent from among the Pharisees and the Herodians. | |
1031 | MRK | 12 | 14 | cp3x | figs-litotes | οὐ μέλει σοι περὶ οὐδενός | 1 | it is not a concern to you about anyone | The negation can modify the verb. Alternate translation: “you do not care about people’s opinions” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]]) |
1032 | MRK | 12 | 14 | xptc | figs-idiom | οὐ μέλει σοι περὶ οὐδενός | 1 | it is not a concern to you about anyone | This is an idiom that means that Jesus does not show favoritism. Alternate translation: “you are not concerned with earning people’s favor” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1033 | MRK | 12 | 15 | g48w | figs-explicit | ὁ…εἰδὼς αὐτῶν τὴν ὑπόκρισιν | 1 | he, knowing their hypocrisy | They were acting hypocritically. This can be explained more clearly. Alternate translation: “Jesus, knowing that they did not really want to know what God wanted them to do” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1034 | MRK | 12 | 15 | c7nj | figs-rquestion | τί με πειράζετε? | 1 | Why do you test me? | Jesus rebukes the Jewish leaders because they were trying to trick him. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “I know you are trying to make me say something wrong so you can accuse me.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1035 | MRK | 12 | 15 | wl34 | translate-bmoney | δηνάριον | 1 | a denarius | This coin was worth a day’s wages. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]]) |
1036 | MRK | 12 | 16 | ev6s | οἱ δὲ ἤνεγκαν | 1 | And they brought one | “So the Pharisees and the Herodians brought a denarius” | |
1037 | MRK | 12 | 16 | wd1n | ἡ εἰκὼν αὕτη καὶ ἡ ἐπιγραφή | 1 | is this likeness and inscription | “is this picture and name” | |
1038 | MRK | 12 | 16 | gi96 | figs-ellipsis | οἱ…εἶπαν αὐτῷ, Καίσαρος | 2 | they said to him, “Caesar’s.” | Here, **Caesar’s** refers to his likeness and inscription. Alternate translation: “they said, ‘They are Caesar’s likeness and inscription” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1039 | MRK | 12 | 17 | fl4l | figs-metonymy | τὰ Καίσαρος ἀπόδοτε Καίσαρι | 1 | The things of Caesar, give back to Caesar | Jesus is teaching that his people must respect the government by paying taxes. This figure of speech can be clarified by changing **Caesar** to Roman government. Alternate translation: “Give to the Roman government the things that belong to the Roman government” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1040 | MRK | 12 | 17 | la16 | figs-ellipsis | καὶ τὰ τοῦ Θεοῦ τῷ Θεῷ | 1 | and the things of God, to God | The understood verb may be supplied. Alternate translation: “and give to God the things of God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1041 | MRK | 12 | 17 | pw4r | figs-explicit | ἐξεθαύμαζον ἐπ’ αὐτῷ | 1 | they were marveling at him | They were amazed at what Jesus had said. This can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “they marveled at him and at what he had said” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1042 | MRK | 12 | 18 | rdl7 | figs-explicit | οἵτινες λέγουσιν ἀνάστασιν μὴ εἶναι | 1 | who say there is no resurrection | This phrase explains who the Sadducees were. This can be written more clearly. Alternate translation: “who say there is no resurrection from the dead” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1043 | MRK | 12 | 19 | e8x2 | figs-quotations | Μωϋσῆς ἔγραψεν ἡμῖν, ὅτι ἐάν τινος ἀδελφὸς ἀποθάνῃ | 1 | Moses wrote to us, ‘If someone’s brother may die | The Sadducees are quoting what **Moses** had written in the law. Moses’ quote can be expressed as an indirect quote. Alternate translation: “Moses wrote for us that if a man’s brother dies” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]]) |
1044 | MRK | 12 | 19 | m8fh | ἔγραψεν ἡμῖν | 1 | wrote to us | “wrote to us Jews.” The Sadducees were a group of Jews. Here they use the word **us** to refer to themselves and all Jews. | |
1045 | MRK | 12 | 19 | g49e | λάβῃ ὁ ἀδελφὸς αὐτοῦ τὴν γυναῖκα | 1 | his brother should take the wife | “the man should marry his brother’s wife” | |
1046 | MRK | 12 | 19 | m2um | figs-explicit | ἐξαναστήσῃ σπέρμα τῷ ἀδελφῷ αὐτοῦ | 1 | should raise up offspring to his brother | “have a son for his brother.” The man’s first son would be considered to be the dead brother’s son, and the son’s descendants would be considered to be the dead brother’s descendants. This can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “should have a son who will be considered to be the dead brother’s son” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1047 | MRK | 12 | 20 | wz27 | figs-hypo | ἑπτὰ ἀδελφοὶ ἦσαν | 1 | There were seven brothers | The Sadducees talk about a situation that did not really happen because they want Jesus to tell them what he thinks is right and wrong. Alternate translation: “Suppose there were seven brothers” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hypo]]) |
1048 | MRK | 12 | 20 | pj71 | ὁ πρῶτος | 1 | the first | the first brother | |
1049 | MRK | 12 | 20 | af1t | ὁ πρῶτος ἔλαβεν γυναῖκα | 1 | the first took a wife | “the first married a woman.” Here marrying a woman is spoken of as “taking” her. | |
1050 | MRK | 12 | 21 | d61g | figs-ellipsis | ὁ δεύτερος…ὁ τρίτος | 1 | the second … the third | These numbers refer to each of the brothers and can be expressed as such. Alternate translation: “the second brother … the third brother” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1051 | MRK | 12 | 21 | na6s | ὁ δεύτερος ἔλαβεν αὐτήν | 1 | the second took her | “the second married her.” Here marrying a woman is spoken of as “taking” her. | |
1052 | MRK | 12 | 21 | l1ds | figs-explicit | ὁ τρίτος ὡσαύτως | 1 | the third likewise | It may be helpful to explain what **likewise** means. Alternate translation: “the third brother married her as his other bothers did, and he also died leaving no children” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1053 | MRK | 12 | 22 | wjq8 | figs-ellipsis | οἱ ἑπτὰ | 1 | the seven | This refers to all the brothers. Alternate translation: “the seven brothers” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1054 | MRK | 12 | 22 | l3dg | figs-explicit | οἱ ἑπτὰ οὐκ ἀφῆκαν σπέρμα | 1 | the seven did not leave offspring | Each of the brothers married the woman and then died before he had any children with her. This can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “eventually all seven brothers married that woman one by one, but none of them had any children with her, and one by one they died” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1055 | MRK | 12 | 23 | w4wu | figs-rquestion | ἐν τῇ ἀναστάσει, ὅταν ἀναστῶσιν, τίνος αὐτῶν ἔσται γυνή | 1 | In the resurrection, when they may rise again, of which of them will she be a wife? | The Sadducees are testing Jesus by asking this question. If your readers can only understand this as a request for information, this can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “Now tell us whose wife she will be in the resurrection, when they all rise again.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1056 | MRK | 12 | 24 | zp2p | figs-rquestion | οὐ διὰ τοῦτο πλανᾶσθε, μὴ εἰδότες τὰς Γραφὰς, μηδὲ τὴν δύναμιν τοῦ Θεοῦ? | 1 | Are you not being led astray because of this, not knowing the scriptures nor the power of God? | Jesus rebukes the Sadducees because they are mistaken about God’s law. This may be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “You are mistaken because you do not know the scriptures nor the power of God.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1057 | MRK | 12 | 24 | li2y | μὴ εἰδότες τὰς Γραφὰς | 1 | not knowing the scriptures | This means that they do not understand what is written in the Old Testament **scriptures**. | |
1058 | MRK | 12 | 24 | i8il | τὴν δύναμιν τοῦ Θεοῦ | 1 | the power of God | “how powerful God is” | |
1059 | MRK | 12 | 25 | nvh6 | ὅταν γὰρ…ἀναστῶσιν | 1 | For when they may rise | Here the word **they** refers to the brothers and the woman from the example. | |
1060 | MRK | 12 | 25 | y8vz | figs-metaphor | ἀναστῶσιν | 1 | they may rise | Waking and getting up from sleep is a metaphor for becoming alive after having been dead. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1061 | MRK | 12 | 25 | vh7r | ἐκ νεκρῶν | 1 | from the dead | From among all those who have died. This expression describes all **dead** people together in the underworld. To rise from among them speaks of becoming alive again. | |
1062 | MRK | 12 | 25 | p5ak | οὔτε γαμοῦσιν οὔτε γαμίζονται | 1 | they neither marry nor are given in marriage | “they do not marry, and they are not given in marriage” | |
1063 | MRK | 12 | 25 | h7ii | figs-activepassive | γαμίζονται | 1 | are given in marriage | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “and no one gives them in marriage” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1064 | MRK | 12 | 25 | pi8l | τοῖς οὐρανοῖς | 1 | the heavens | This refers to the place where God lives. | |
1065 | MRK | 12 | 26 | z36n | figs-activepassive | ὅτι ἐγείρονται | 1 | that are raised | This can be expressed with an active verb. Alternate translation: “who rise” or “who rise to live again” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1066 | MRK | 12 | 26 | jc5a | τῇ βίβλῳ Μωϋσέως | 1 | the book of Moses | “the book that Moses wrote” | |
1067 | MRK | 12 | 26 | w2lj | figs-explicit | τοῦ βάτου | 1 | the bush | This refers to the part of the Book of Moses that tells about when God spoke to Moses out of a **bush** that was burning but that did not burn up. Alternate translation: “the passage about the burning bush” or “the words about the fiery bush” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1068 | MRK | 12 | 26 | si2b | τοῦ βάτου | 1 | the bush | This refers to a shrub, a woody plant that is smaller than a tree. | |
1069 | MRK | 12 | 26 | y35v | πῶς εἶπεν αὐτῷ ὁ Θεὸς | 1 | how God spoke to him | “about when God spoke to Moses” | |
1070 | MRK | 12 | 26 | re82 | ἐγὼ ὁ Θεὸς Ἀβραὰμ, καὶ ὁ Θεὸς Ἰσαὰκ, καὶ ὁ Θεὸς Ἰακώβ | 1 | I am the God of Abraham and the God of Isaac and the God of Jacob | This means that **Abraham**, **Isaac**, and **Jacob** worship **God**. These men have died physically, but they are still alive spiritually and still worship God. | |
1071 | MRK | 12 | 27 | dgc9 | figs-nominaladj | Θεὸς νεκρῶν, ἀλλὰ ζώντων | 1 | the God of the dead, but of the living | Here, **the dead** refers to people who are dead, and **the living** refers to people who are alive. Alternate translation: “not the God of dead people, but of living people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]]) |
1072 | MRK | 12 | 27 | v7ui | figs-ellipsis | Θεὸς νεκρῶν, ἀλλὰ ζώντων | 1 | the God of the dead, but of the living | Here, **the God** can be stated clearly in the second phrase. Alternate translation: “not the God of dead people, but the God of living people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1073 | MRK | 12 | 27 | l22e | ζώντων | 1 | of the living | This includes people who are alive physically and spiritually. | |
1074 | MRK | 12 | 27 | wmz2 | figs-explicit | πολὺ πλανᾶσθε | 1 | You are quite being led astray | It may be helpful to state what they are lead astray about. Alternate translation: “When you say that dead people do not rise again, you are quite mistaken” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1075 | MRK | 12 | 27 | sp7x | πολὺ πλανᾶσθε | 1 | You are quite being led astray | “You are completely mistaken” or “You are very wrong” | |
1076 | MRK | 12 | 28 | q1u5 | ἐπηρώτησεν αὐτόν | 1 | he asked him | “the scribe asked Jesus” | |
1077 | MRK | 12 | 29 | n74y | figs-nominaladj | πρώτη ἐστίν | 1 | The first is | Here, **The first** refers to the most important commandment. Alternate translation: “The most important commandment is” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]]) |
1078 | MRK | 12 | 29 | mq92 | ἄκουε, Ἰσραήλ, Κύριος ὁ Θεὸς ἡμῶν Κύριος εἷς ἐστιν | 1 | Hear, O Israel, the Lord our God, the Lord is one | “Listen, O Israel! The Lord our God is one Lord” | |
1079 | MRK | 12 | 30 | xjng | figs-doublet | ἐξ ὅλης τῆς καρδίας σου, καὶ ἐξ ὅλης τῆς ψυχῆς σου, καὶ ἐξ ὅλης τῆς διανοίας σου, καὶ ἐξ ὅλης τῆς ἰσχύος σου | 1 | from your whole heart … from your whole soul … from your whole mind … from your whole strength | These four phrases are used together to mean “completely” or “earnestly.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]]) |
1080 | MRK | 12 | 30 | q49v | figs-metonymy | ἐξ ὅλης τῆς καρδίας σου, καὶ ἐξ ὅλης τῆς ψυχῆς σου | 1 | from your whole heart, and from your whole soul | Here, **heart** and “soul” are metonyms for a person’s inner being. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1081 | MRK | 12 | 31 | tp6p | figs-simile | ἀγαπήσεις τὸν πλησίον σου ὡς σεαυτόν | 1 | You will love your neighbor as yourself | Jesus uses this simile to compare how people are to love each other with the same love as they love themselves. Alternate translation: “You must love your neighbor as much as you love yourself” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]]) |
1082 | MRK | 12 | 31 | pyc1 | τούτων | 1 | than these | Here the word **these** refers to the two commandments that Jesus had just told the people. | |
1083 | MRK | 12 | 32 | qqm4 | καλῶς, Διδάσκαλε | 1 | Good, Teacher | “Good answer, Teacher” or “Well said, Teacher” | |
1084 | MRK | 12 | 32 | awe3 | figs-idiom | εἷς ἐστιν | 1 | he is one | This means that there is only **one** God. Alternate translation: “there is only one God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1085 | MRK | 12 | 32 | as2j | figs-ellipsis | οὐκ ἔστιν ἄλλος | 1 | that there is no other | The word “God” is understood from the previous phrase. Alternate translation: “that there is no other God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1086 | MRK | 12 | 33 | xnq9 | figs-doublet | ἐξ ὅλης τῆς καρδίας…ἐξ ὅλης τῆς συνέσεως…ἐξ ὅλης τῆς ἰσχύος | 1 | from your whole heart … from your whole understanding … from your whole strength | These three phrases are used together to mean “completely” or “earnestly.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]]) |
1087 | MRK | 12 | 33 | k42a | figs-metonymy | ἐξ ὅλης τῆς καρδίας | 1 | from your whole heart | Here, **heart** is a metonym for person’s thoughts, feelings, or inner being. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1088 | MRK | 12 | 33 | tw15 | figs-simile | τὸ ἀγαπᾶν τὸν πλησίον ὡς ἑαυτὸν | 1 | to love your neighbor as yourself | This simile compares how people are **to love** each other with the same love that they love themselves. Alternate translation: “to love your neighbor as much as you love yourself” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]]) |
1089 | MRK | 12 | 33 | ll9t | figs-idiom | περισσότερόν ἐστιν | 1 | is even more than | This idiom means that something is more important than something else. In this case, these two commandments are more pleasing to God that burnt offering and sacrifices. This may be written clearly. Alternate translation: “is even more important than” or “is even more pleasing to God than” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1090 | MRK | 12 | 34 | b144 | figs-litotes | οὐ μακρὰν εἶ ἀπὸ τῆς Βασιλείας τοῦ Θεοῦ | 1 | You are not far from the kingdom of God | This can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “You are very close to the kingdom of God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]]) |
1091 | MRK | 12 | 34 | is4c | figs-metaphor | οὐ μακρὰν εἶ ἀπὸ τῆς Βασιλείας τοῦ Θεοῦ | 1 | You are not far from the kingdom of God | Here Jesus speaks of the man being ready to submit to God as king as being physically close to **the kingdom of God**, as if it where a physical place. Alternate translation: “You are close to submitting to God as king” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1092 | MRK | 12 | 34 | rgh8 | figs-litotes | οὐδεὶς οὐκέτι ἐτόλμα | 1 | no one any longer was daring | This can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “everyone was afraid” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]]) |
1093 | MRK | 12 | 35 | ptc8 | figs-explicit | ἀποκριθεὶς ὁ Ἰησοῦς ἔλεγεν διδάσκων ἐν τῷ ἱερῷ | 1 | answering, Jesus, teaching in the temple, said | Some time has passed and Jesus is now in the temple. This is not part of the previous conversation. Alternate translation: “And later, while Jesus was teaching in the temple area, he said to the people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1094 | MRK | 12 | 35 | q6e4 | figs-rquestion | πῶς λέγουσιν οἱ γραμματεῖς ὅτι ὁ Χριστὸς, υἱὸς Δαυείδ ἐστιν? | 1 | How do the scribes say that the Christ is the son of David? | Jesus uses this question to get the people to think deeply about the Psalm he is about to quote. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “Consider why the scribes say the Christ is the son of David.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1095 | MRK | 12 | 35 | i6a4 | υἱὸς Δαυείδ | 1 | the son of David | “a descendant of David” | |
1096 | MRK | 12 | 36 | e1zq | figs-rpronouns | αὐτὸς Δαυεὶδ | 1 | David himself | This word **himself** refers to **David** and is used to place emphasis on him and what he said. Alternate translation: “It was David who” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rpronouns]]) |
1097 | MRK | 12 | 36 | ejy2 | figs-idiom | ἐν τῷ Πνεύματι τῷ ἁγίῳ | 1 | in the Holy Spirit | This means that he was inspired by **the Holy Spirit**. That is, the Holy Spirit directed David in what he said. Alternate translation: “inspired by the Holy Spirit” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1098 | MRK | 12 | 36 | dv7b | figs-explicit | εἶπεν…εἶπεν ὁ Κύριος τῷ Κυρίῳ μου | 1 | said, ‘The Lord said to my Lord | Here David calls God **The Lord** and calls the Christ **my Lord**. This can be written more clearly. Alternate translation: “said about the Christ, ‘The Lord God said to my Lord” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1099 | MRK | 12 | 36 | v53p | translate-symaction | κάθου ἐκ δεξιῶν μου | 1 | Sit at my right hand | Jesus is quoting a psalm. Here God is speaking to the Christ. To sit at the **right hand** of God is a symbolic action of receiving great honor and authority from God. Alternate translation: “Sit in the place of honor beside me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]]) |
1100 | MRK | 12 | 36 | mml8 | figs-metaphor | ἕως ἂν θῶ τοὺς ἐχθρούς σου ὑποκάτω τῶν ποδῶν σου | 1 | until I may place your enemies under your feet | In this quote, God speaks of defeating enemies as placing them under his feet. Alternate translation: “until I completely defeat your enemies” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1101 | MRK | 12 | 37 | ka5u | λέγει αὐτὸν, Κύριον | 1 | calls him ‘Lord,’ | Here the word **him** refers to the Christ. | |
1102 | MRK | 12 | 37 | rh2t | figs-rquestion | καὶ πόθεν υἱός αὐτοῦ ἐστιν? | 1 | and how is he his son? | This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “so consider how the Christ can be a descendant of David” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1103 | MRK | 12 | 38 | z649 | figs-abstractnouns | ἀσπασμοὺς ἐν ταῖς ἀγοραῖς | 1 | greetings in the marketplaces | The noun **greetings** can be expressed with the verb “greet.” Alternate translation: “for people to greet them in the marketplaces” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]]) |
1104 | MRK | 12 | 38 | k31m | figs-explicit | ἀσπασμοὺς ἐν ταῖς ἀγοραῖς | 1 | greetings in the marketplaces | These greetings showed that the people respected the scribes. Alternate translation: “to be greeted respectfully in the marketplaces” or “for people to greet them respectfully in the marketplaces” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1105 | MRK | 12 | 40 | jtw4 | figs-metaphor | οἱ κατεσθίοντες τὰς οἰκίας τῶν χηρῶν | 1 | They devour the houses of the widows | Here Jesus describes the scribes’ cheating of **widows** and stealing of their **houses** as “devouring” their houses. Alternate translation: “They also cheat widows in order to steal their houses from them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1106 | MRK | 12 | 40 | j27b | figs-synecdoche | τὰς οἰκίας τῶν χηρῶν | 1 | the houses of the widows | The words **widows** and **houses** are synecdoches for helpless people and all of a person’s important possessions, respectively. Alternate translation: “everything from helpless people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
1107 | MRK | 12 | 40 | qm52 | figs-activepassive | οὗτοι λήμψονται περισσότερον κρίμα | 1 | These will receive greater condemnation | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will certainly punish them with greater condemnation” or “God will certainly punish them severely” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1108 | MRK | 12 | 40 | h36x | figs-explicit | λήμψονται περισσότερον κρίμα | 1 | will receive greater condemnation | The word **greater** implies a comparison. Here the comparison is to other men who are punished. Alternate translation: “will receive greater condemnation than other people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1109 | MRK | 12 | 41 | r69x | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Still in the temple area, Jesus comments on the value of the widow’s offering. | ||
1110 | MRK | 12 | 41 | p2kp | τοῦ γαζοφυλακίου | 1 | the temple offering box | This **box**, which everyone could use, was the place into which people gave offerings to the **temple**. | |
1111 | MRK | 12 | 42 | g6ry | translate-bmoney | λεπτὰ δύο | 1 | two mites | “two small copper coins.” These were the least valuable coins available. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]]) |
1112 | MRK | 12 | 42 | n29e | ἐστιν κοδράντης | 1 | are a quadrans | “are worth very little.” A **quadrans** is worth very little. Translate **quadrans** with the name of the smallest coin in your language if you have one that is worth very little. | |
1113 | MRK | 12 | 43 | ipl1 | translate-versebridge | 0 | General Information: | In verse 43 Jesus says that the widow put more money in the offering than the rich people put in, and in verse 44 he tells his reason for saying that. The information can be reordered so that Jesus tells his reason first and then says that the widow put in more, as in the UST. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-versebridge]]) | |
1114 | MRK | 12 | 43 | n7su | προσκαλεσάμενος | 1 | having called | “when Jesus had called” | |
1115 | MRK | 12 | 43 | q124 | ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν | 1 | Truly I say to you | This indicates that the statement that follows is especially true and important. See how you translated this in [Mark 3:28](../03/28.md). | |
1116 | MRK | 12 | 43 | n8z5 | πάντων…τῶν βαλλόντων εἰς | 1 | all of those putting into | “all the other people who put money into” | |
1117 | MRK | 12 | 44 | ui9a | τοῦ περισσεύοντος | 1 | abundance | much wealth, many valuable things | |
1118 | MRK | 12 | 44 | l4tp | τῆς ὑστερήσεως αὐτῆς | 1 | her poverty | “her lack” or “the little she had” | |
1119 | MRK | 12 | 44 | p3as | τὸν βίον αὐτῆς | 1 | of her livelihood | “she had to survive on” | |
1120 | MRK | 13 | intro | ti7d | 0 | # Mark 13 General Notes<br><br>## Structure and formatting<br><br>Some translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 13:24-25, which are words from the Old Testament.<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### The return of Christ<br><br>Jesus said much about what would happen before he returned ([Mark 13:6-37](./06.md)). He told his followers that bad things would happen to the world and bad things would happen to them before he returned, but they needed to be ready for him to return at any time. | |||
1121 | MRK | 13 | 1 | rrv1 | 0 | General Information: | As they leave the temple area, Jesus tells his disciples what will happen in the future to the wonderful temple that Herod the Great has built. | ||
1122 | MRK | 13 | 1 | ql81 | figs-explicit | ποταποὶ λίθοι καὶ ποταπαὶ οἰκοδομαί | 1 | What wonderful stones and wonderful buildings | The **stones** refer to the stones that the **buildings** were built with. Alternate translation: “What wonderful buildings and the wonderful stones that they are made of” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1123 | MRK | 13 | 2 | rez6 | figs-rquestion | βλέπεις ταύτας τὰς μεγάλας οἰκοδομάς? οὐ μὴ ἀφεθῇ ὧδε λίθος ἐπὶ λίθον | 1 | Do you see these great buildings? Stone upon stone may certainly not be left here | This question is used to draw attention to the buildings. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “Look at these great buildings! Not one stone will be left stacked on top of another” or “You see these great buildings now, but not a single stone will be left” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1124 | MRK | 13 | 2 | zu46 | figs-explicit | οὐ μὴ ἀφεθῇ ὧδε λίθος ἐπὶ λίθον, ὃς οὐ μὴ καταλυθῇ | 1 | Stone upon stone may certainly not be left here, which may certainly not be torn down | It is implied that enemy soldiers will tear down the stones. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1125 | MRK | 13 | 2 | xdhj | figs-activepassive | οὐ μὴ ἀφεθῇ ὧδε λίθος ἐπὶ λίθον, ὃς οὐ μὴ καταλυθῇ | 1 | Stone upon stone may certainly not be left here, which may certainly not be torn down | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Not one stone will remain on top of another, for enemy soldiers will come and destroy these buildings” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1126 | MRK | 13 | 3 | e913 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | In answer to the disciples’ questions about the temple’s destruction and what was going to happen, Jesus tells them what was going to take place in the future. | ||
1127 | MRK | 13 | 3 | izt8 | figs-explicit | καὶ καθημένου αὐτοῦ εἰς τὸ Ὄρος τῶν Ἐλαιῶν κατέναντι τοῦ ἱεροῦ…Πέτρος | 1 | And as he was sitting on the Mount of Olives opposite the temple, Peter | It can be expressed clearly that Jesus and his disciples had walked to **the Mount of Olives**. Alternate translation: “And after arriving at the Mount of Olives, which is opposite the temple, Jesus sat down. Then Peter” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1128 | MRK | 13 | 3 | u7ju | κατ’ ἰδίαν | 1 | by himself | when they were alone | |
1129 | MRK | 13 | 4 | uf37 | figs-explicit | πότε ταῦτα ἔσται, καὶ τί τὸ σημεῖον ὅταν μέλλῃ ταῦτα συντελεῖσθαι πάντα | 1 | when will these things be? And what is the sign when all these things are about to be fulfilled | This refers to what Jesus had just said will happen to the stones of the temple. This can be made clear. Alternate translation: “when will these things happen to the buildings of the temple, and what will be the sign that these things are about to happen to the temple buildings” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1130 | MRK | 13 | 4 | lw1n | ὅταν…ταῦτα…πάντα | 1 | when all these things | “that all these things” | |
1131 | MRK | 13 | 5 | fe42 | λέγειν αὐτοῖς | 1 | to say to them | “to say to his disciples” | |
1132 | MRK | 13 | 5 | u79c | figs-metaphor | ὑμᾶς πλανήσῃ | 1 | may lead you astray | Here, **lead you astray** is a metaphor for persuading someone to believe what is not true. Alternate translation: “deceives you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1133 | MRK | 13 | 6 | wv12 | figs-metaphor | πολλοὺς πλανήσουσιν | 1 | they will lead many astray | Here, **will lead many astray** is a metaphor for persuading someone to believe what is not true. Alternate translation: “they will deceive many people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1134 | MRK | 13 | 6 | z63u | figs-metonymy | ἐπὶ τῷ ὀνόματί μου | 1 | in my name | This could mean: (1) “claiming my authority” or (2) “claiming that God sent them.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1135 | MRK | 13 | 6 | l7f9 | ἐγώ εἰμι | 1 | I am | “I am the Christ” | |
1136 | MRK | 13 | 7 | fl5h | ἀκούσητε πολέμους καὶ ἀκοὰς πολέμων | 1 | you may hear of wars and rumors of wars | “you may hear of wars and reports about wars.” This could mean: (1) “hear the sounds of wars close by and news of wars far away” or (2) “hear of wars that have started and reports about wars that are about to start” | |
1137 | MRK | 13 | 7 | d1k9 | ἀλλ’ οὔπω τὸ τέλος | 1 | but the end is not yet | “but it is not yet the end” or “but the end will not happen until later” or “but the end will be later” | |
1138 | MRK | 13 | 7 | mi4d | figs-explicit | τὸ τέλος | 1 | the end | This probably refers to **the end** of the world. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1139 | MRK | 13 | 8 | xln4 | figs-idiom | ἐγερθήσεται…ἐπ’ | 1 | will rise against | This idiom means to fight against one another. Alternate translation: “will fight against” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1140 | MRK | 13 | 8 | e2ln | figs-ellipsis | βασιλεία ἐπὶ βασιλείαν | 1 | kingdom against kingdom | The words “will rise” are understood from the previous phrase. Alternate translation: “kingdom will rise against kingdom” or “the people of one kingdom will fight against the people of another kingdom” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1141 | MRK | 13 | 8 | dz8g | figs-metaphor | ἀρχὴ ὠδίνων ταῦτα | 1 | These are the beginnings of birth pains | Jesus speaks of these disasters as **the beginnings of birth pains** because more severe things will happen after them. Alternate translation: “These events will be like the first pains a woman suffers when she is about to bear a child” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1142 | MRK | 13 | 9 | c2cl | βλέπετε δὲ ὑμεῖς ἑαυτούς | 1 | But you, watch yourselves | “But be ready for what people will do to you” | |
1143 | MRK | 13 | 9 | xsy1 | παραδώσουσιν ὑμᾶς εἰς συνέδρια | 1 | They will deliver you to councils | “They will take you and put you under the control of councils” | |
1144 | MRK | 13 | 9 | zdp8 | figs-activepassive | δαρήσεσθε | 1 | you will be beaten | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “people will beat you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1145 | MRK | 13 | 9 | gbb4 | figs-idiom | ἐπὶ…σταθήσεσθε | 1 | you will be made to stand before | This means to be put on trial and judged. Alternate translation: “you will be put on trial before” or “you will be brought to trial and judged by” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1146 | MRK | 13 | 9 | y6p6 | figs-explicit | εἰς μαρτύριον αὐτοῖς | 1 | for a testimony to them | This means the disciples will testify about Jesus. This can be made clear. Alternate translation: “and will testify to them about me” or “and you will tell them about me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1147 | MRK | 13 | 10 | ruk9 | figs-explicit | καὶ εἰς πάντα τὰ ἔθνη πρῶτον δεῖ κηρυχθῆναι τὸ εὐαγγέλιον | 1 | But first, it is necessary for the gospel to be proclaimed to all the nations | Jesus is still speaking about things that must happen before the end comes. This can be made clear. Alternate translation: “But the gospel must first be proclaimed to all the nations before the end will come” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1148 | MRK | 13 | 11 | uy91 | figs-idiom | παραδιδόντες | 1 | handing you over | Here this means to put people under the control of the authorities. Alternate translation: “giving you over to the authorities” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1149 | MRK | 13 | 11 | a9b6 | figs-ellipsis | ἀλλὰ τὸ Πνεῦμα τὸ Ἅγιον | 1 | but the Holy Spirit | The words “will speak” are understood from the previous phrase. Alternate translation: “but the Holy Spirit will speak through you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1150 | MRK | 13 | 12 | py9u | παραδώσει ἀδελφὸς ἀδελφὸν εἰς θάνατον | 1 | brother will deliver brother to death | “one brother will put another brother under the control of people who will kill him” or “brothers will put their brothers under the control of people who will kill them.” This will happen many times to many different people. Jesus is not speaking of just one person and his brother. | |
1151 | MRK | 13 | 12 | g3jv | figs-gendernotations | ἀδελφὸς ἀδελφὸν | 1 | brother … brother | These refers to both brothers and sisters. Alternate translation: “people … their siblings” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-gendernotations]]) |
1152 | MRK | 13 | 12 | b9ux | figs-ellipsis | πατὴρ τέκνον | 1 | a father, his child | The words “will deliver up to death” are understood from the previous phrase. Alternate translation: “fathers will deliver up their children to death” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1153 | MRK | 13 | 12 | d0t9 | figs-idiom | πατὴρ τέκνον | 1 | a father, his child | This means that some fathers will betray their children, and this betrayal will cause their children to be killed. Alternate translation: “fathers will betray their children, handing them over to be killed” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1154 | MRK | 13 | 12 | r66s | figs-idiom | ἐπαναστήσονται τέκνα ἐπὶ γονεῖς | 1 | children will rise up against parents | This means that **children** will oppose their **parents** and betray them. Alternate translation: “children will oppose their parents” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1155 | MRK | 13 | 12 | si65 | figs-activepassive | θανατώσουσιν αὐτούς | 1 | put them to death | This means that the authorities will sentence the parents to be put to death. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “cause the authorities to sentence the parents to die” or “the authorities will kill the parents” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1156 | MRK | 13 | 13 | pk3g | figs-activepassive | ἔσεσθε μισούμενοι ὑπὸ πάντων | 1 | you will be hated by everyone | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “everyone will hate you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1157 | MRK | 13 | 13 | jhp6 | figs-metonymy | διὰ τὸ ὄνομά μου | 1 | because of my name | Jesus uses the metonym **my name** to refer to himself. Alternate translation: “because of me” or “because you believe in me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1158 | MRK | 13 | 13 | w28q | figs-activepassive | ὁ…ὑπομείνας εἰς τέλος, οὗτος σωθήσεται | 1 | the one who endures to the end, that one will be saved | This may be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “whoever endures to the end, God will save that person” or “God will save whoever endures to the end” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1159 | MRK | 13 | 13 | c33n | figs-explicit | ὁ…ὑπομείνας εἰς τέλος | 1 | the one who endures to the end | Here, **endures** represents continuing to be faithful to God even while suffering. Alternate translation: “whoever suffers and stays faithful to God to the end” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1160 | MRK | 13 | 13 | vcz4 | εἰς τέλος | 1 | to the end | This could mean: (1) “to the end of his life” or (2) “to the end of that time of trouble” | |
1161 | MRK | 13 | 14 | d4nw | figs-metaphor | τὸ βδέλυγμα τῆς ἐρημώσεως | 1 | the abomination of desolation | This phrase is from the book of Daniel. His audience would have been familiar with this passage and the prophecy about **the abomination** entering the temple and defiling it. Alternate translation: “the shameful thing that defiles the things of God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1162 | MRK | 13 | 14 | vx3c | figs-explicit | ἑστηκότα ὅπου οὐ δεῖ | 1 | standing where it should not be | Jesus’ audience would have known that this refers to the temple. This can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “standing in the temple, where it should not be standing” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1163 | MRK | 13 | 14 | ck7a | figs-explicit | ὁ ἀναγινώσκων νοείτω | 1 | let the reader understand | This is not Jesus speaking. Matthew added this to get the readers’ attention, so that they would listen to this warning. Alternate translation: “may everyone who is reading this pay attention to this warning” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1164 | MRK | 13 | 15 | m1hq | ἐπὶ τοῦ δώματος | 1 | on the housetop | Where Jesus lived, the tops of houses were flat, and people could stand on them. | |
1165 | MRK | 13 | 16 | y1e9 | figs-ellipsis | ὁ εἰς τὸν ἀγρὸν, μὴ ἐπιστρεψάτω εἰς τὰ ὀπίσω | 1 | let the one in the field not turn back to the things behind | This refers to returning to his house. This can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “the one who is in the field should not return to his house” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1166 | MRK | 13 | 17 | bi8n | figs-euphemism | ταῖς ἐν γαστρὶ ἐχούσαις | 1 | to those having in the womb | This is a polite way to say that someone is pregnant. Alternate translation: “to women who are pregnant” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]]) |
1167 | MRK | 13 | 18 | w47v | προσεύχεσθε…ἵνα | 1 | pray that | “pray that these times” or “pray that these things” | |
1168 | MRK | 13 | 18 | w91r | χειμῶνος | 1 | in winter | “in the cold season” or “in the cold, rainy season.” This refers to the time of year when it is cold and unpleasant and difficult to travel. | |
1169 | MRK | 13 | 19 | e98e | οἵα οὐ γέγονεν τοιαύτη | 1 | such as these have not happened | “there has never been a worse time.” This describes how great and terrible the tribulation will be. There has never been a tribulation as terrible as this one will be. | |
1170 | MRK | 13 | 19 | c5sz | οὐ μὴ γένηται | 1 | may certainly not happen | “there will never be days like these again” or “after that tribulation, there will never again be a tribulation like it” | |
1171 | MRK | 13 | 20 | y7g6 | figs-explicit | μὴ ἐκολόβωσεν…τὰς ἡμέρας | 1 | did not cut short the days | “did not shorten the time.” It may be helpful to specify which **days** are referred to. Alternate translation: “had not reduced the days of suffering” or “had not shortened the time of suffering” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1172 | MRK | 13 | 20 | kda6 | figs-synecdoche | οὐκ ἂν ἐσώθη πᾶσα σάρξ | 1 | no flesh would be saved | The word **flesh** refers to people, and **saved** refers to physical salvation. Alternate translation: “no one would be saved” or “everyone would die” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
1173 | MRK | 13 | 20 | q8hm | διὰ τοὺς ἐκλεκτοὺς | 1 | for the sake of the elect | “in order to help the elect” | |
1174 | MRK | 13 | 20 | er43 | figs-doublet | τοὺς ἐκλεκτοὺς, οὓς ἐξελέξατο | 1 | the elect whom he chose | The phrase **whom he chose** means the same thing as **the elect**. Together, they emphasize that God chose these people. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]]) |
1175 | MRK | 13 | 21 | d9gr | translate-versebridge | 0 | General Information: | In verse 21 Jesus gives a command, and in 22 he tells the reason for the command. This can be reordered with the reason first, and the command second, as in the UST. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-versebridge]]) | |
1176 | MRK | 13 | 22 | n81i | ψευδόχριστοι | 1 | false Christs | “people who claim they are Christ” | |
1177 | MRK | 13 | 22 | yw81 | πρὸς τὸ ἀποπλανᾶν | 1 | to deceive | “in order to deceive” or “hoping to deceive” or “trying to deceive” | |
1178 | MRK | 13 | 22 | j198 | figs-ellipsis | πρὸς τὸ ἀποπλανᾶν εἰ δυνατὸν τοὺς ἐκλεκτούς | 1 | to deceive, if possible, even the elect | The phrase **even the elect** implies that the false Christs and false prophets will expect to deceive some people, but they will not know if they will be able to deceive the elect. Alternate translation: “in order to deceive people, and even deceive the elect, if that is possible” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1179 | MRK | 13 | 23 | jq8p | ὑμεῖς δὲ βλέπετε | 1 | But you, watch out | “Be watchful” or “Be alert” | |
1180 | MRK | 13 | 23 | va6h | figs-explicit | προείρηκα ὑμῖν πάντα | 1 | I have told you everything beforehand | Jesus told them these things to warn them. Alternate translation: “I have told you all these things ahead of time to warn you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1181 | MRK | 13 | 24 | zy2f | figs-activepassive | ὁ ἥλιος σκοτισθήσεται | 1 | the sun will be darkened | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the sun will become dark” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1182 | MRK | 13 | 24 | a3qv | figs-personification | ἡ σελήνη οὐ δώσει τὸ φέγγος αὐτῆς | 1 | the moon will not give its light | Here the **moon** is spoken of as if it were alive and able to give something to someone else. Alternate translation: “the moon will not shine” or “the moon will be dark” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]]) |
1183 | MRK | 13 | 25 | z1sh | figs-explicit | οἱ ἀστέρες ἔσονται ἐκ τοῦ οὐρανοῦ πίπτοντες | 1 | the stars will be falling from the sky | This does not mean that they will fall to earth but that they will fall from where the are now. Alternate translation: “the stars will fall from their places in the sky” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1184 | MRK | 13 | 25 | au6l | figs-activepassive | αἱ δυνάμεις αἱ ἐν τοῖς οὐρανοῖς σαλευθήσονται | 1 | the powers that are in the heavens will be shaken | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the powers in the heavens will shake” or “God will shake the powers that are in the heavens” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1185 | MRK | 13 | 25 | hge7 | αἱ δυνάμεις αἱ ἐν τοῖς οὐρανοῖς | 1 | the powers that are in the heavens | “the powerful things in the heavens.” This could mean: (1) the sun, moon, and stars or (2) powerful spiritual beings | |
1186 | MRK | 13 | 25 | h5k1 | ἐν τοῖς οὐρανοῖς | 1 | in the heavens | “in the sky” | |
1187 | MRK | 13 | 26 | kl95 | τότε ὄψονται | 1 | then they will see | “then people will see” | |
1188 | MRK | 13 | 26 | h4z1 | μετὰ δυνάμεως πολλῆς καὶ δόξης | 1 | with great power and glory | “powerfully and gloriously” | |
1189 | MRK | 13 | 27 | a1z2 | figs-metonymy | ἐπισυνάξει | 1 | he will gather together | The word **he** refers to God and is a metonym for his angels, as they are the ones who **will gather** the elect. Alternate translation: “they will gather” or “his angels will gather” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1190 | MRK | 13 | 27 | vpb6 | figs-metaphor | τῶν τεσσάρων ἀνέμων | 1 | the four winds | The whole earth is spoken of as **the four winds**, which refer to the four directions: north, south, east, and west. Alternate translation: “the north, south, east, and west” or “all parts of the earth” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1191 | MRK | 13 | 27 | u1vp | figs-merism | ἀπ’ ἄκρου γῆς ἕως ἄκρου οὐρανοῦ | 1 | from the end of the earth to the end of the sky | These two extremes are given to emphasize that the elect will be gathered from the entire earth. Alternate translation: “from every place on earth” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-merism]]) |
1192 | MRK | 13 | 28 | c99s | figs-parables | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus gives two short parables here to remind people to be aware when the things that he has been explaining happen. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]]) | |
1193 | MRK | 13 | 28 | u8ha | ἁπαλὸς | 1 | tender | “green and soft” | |
1194 | MRK | 13 | 28 | q6yc | figs-personification | ἐκφύῃ τὰ φύλλα | 1 | may put out its leaves | Here the fig tree is spoken of as if it were alive and able to willingly cause its **leaves** to grow. Alternate translation: “its leaves begin to sprout” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]]) |
1195 | MRK | 13 | 28 | z417 | τὸ θέρος | 1 | summer | the warm part of the year or the growing season | |
1196 | MRK | 13 | 29 | q53b | figs-explicit | ταῦτα | 1 | these things | This refers to the days of tribulation. Alternate translation: “these things I have just described” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1197 | MRK | 13 | 29 | aul8 | ἐγγύς ἐστιν | 1 | he is near | “the Son of Man is near” | |
1198 | MRK | 13 | 29 | z2pf | figs-idiom | ἐπὶ θύραις | 1 | at the doors | This idiom means that he is very near and has almost arrived, referring to a traveler being close to arriving at the city gates. Alternate translation: “and is almost here” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1199 | MRK | 13 | 30 | tg35 | ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν | 1 | Truly I say to you | This indicates that the statement that follows is especially important. See how you translated this in [Mark 3:28](../03/28.md). | |
1200 | MRK | 13 | 30 | h72r | figs-euphemism | οὐ μὴ παρέλθῃ | 1 | will certainly not pass away | This is a polite way to talk about someone dying. Alternate translation: “will not die” or “will not end” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]]) |
1201 | MRK | 13 | 30 | t66q | μέχρις οὗ ταῦτα πάντα | 1 | until all these things | The phrase **these things** refers to the days of tribulation. | |
1202 | MRK | 13 | 31 | k4zb | figs-merism | ὁ οὐρανὸς καὶ ἡ γῆ | 1 | Heaven and earth | The two extremes are given to refer to all of the sky, including the sun, moon, stars, and planets, and all of the earth. Alternate translation: “The sky, the earth, and everything in them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-merism]]) |
1203 | MRK | 13 | 31 | bjr8 | παρελεύσονται | 1 | will pass away | “will cease to exist.” Here this phrase refers to the world ending. | |
1204 | MRK | 13 | 31 | ah6w | figs-metaphor | οἱ…λόγοι μου οὐ μὴ παρελεύσονται | 1 | my words will certainly not pass away | Jesus speaks of **words** not losing their power as if they were something that will never physically die. Alternate translation: “my words will never lose their power” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1205 | MRK | 13 | 32 | km5z | figs-explicit | τῆς ἡμέρας ἐκείνης ἢ τῆς ὥρας | 1 | that day or that hour | This refers to the time that the Son of Man will return. Alternate translation: “that day or that hour that the Son of Man will return” or “the day or the hour that I will return” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1206 | MRK | 13 | 32 | btq5 | figs-ellipsis | οὐδεὶς οἶδεν; οὐδὲ οἱ ἄγγελοι ἐν οὐρανῷ, οὐδὲ ὁ Υἱός, εἰ μὴ ὁ Πατήρ | 1 | no one knows, not even the angels in heaven, nor the Son, except the Father | These words specify some of those who do not know when the Son of Man will return, different from **the Father**, who does know. Alternate translation: “no one knows—neither the angels in heaven nor the Son know—but the Father” or “neither the angels in heaven nor the Son know; no one knows but the Father” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1207 | MRK | 13 | 32 | z3q9 | οἱ ἄγγελοι ἐν οὐρανῷ | 1 | the angels in heaven | Here, **heaven** refers to the place where God lives. | |
1208 | MRK | 13 | 32 | gwh2 | figs-ellipsis | εἰ μὴ ὁ Πατήρ | 1 | except the Father | It is best to translate **Father** with the same word that your language naturally uses to refer to a human father. Also, this is an ellipsis, stating that the Father knows when the Son will return. Alternate translation: “but only the Father knows” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1209 | MRK | 13 | 33 | i43k | figs-explicit | πότε ὁ καιρός ἐστιν | 1 | what time it is | It can be stated clearly what **time** refers to here. Alternate translation: “when all these events will happen” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1210 | MRK | 13 | 35 | z7wi | ἢ ὀψὲ | 1 | whether evening | “he could return in the evening” | |
1211 | MRK | 13 | 35 | s8j9 | ἀλεκτοροφωνίας | 1 | when the rooster crows | The **rooster** is a bird that **crows** very early in the morning by making a loud call. | |
1212 | MRK | 13 | 36 | mh8t | figs-metaphor | εὕρῃ ὑμᾶς καθεύδοντας | 1 | he might find you sleeping | Here Jesus speaks of not being ready as **sleeping**. Alternate translation: “find you not ready for his return” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1213 | MRK | 14 | intro | uk36 | 0 | # Mark 14 General Notes<br><br>## Structure and formatting<br><br>Some translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 14:27, 62, which are words from the Old Testament.<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### The eating of the body and blood<br><br>[Mark 14:22-25](./22.md) describes Jesus’ last meal with his followers. At this time, Jesus told them that what they were eating and drinking were his body and his blood. Nearly all Christian churches celebrate “the Lord’s Supper,” the “Eucharist”, or “Holy Communion” to remember this meal.<br><br>## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter<br><br>### Abba, Father<br><br>“Abba” is an Aramaic word that the Jews used to speak to their fathers. Mark writes it as it sounds and then translates it. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]])<br><br>### “Son of Man”<br><br>Jesus refers to himself as the “Son of Man” in this chapter ([Mark 14:20](../../mrk/14/20.md)). Your language may not allow people to speak of themselves as if they were speaking about someone else. (See: [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/kt/sonofman]] and [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]]) | |||
1214 | MRK | 14 | 1 | hwb4 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Just two days before the Passover, the chief priests and scribes are secretly plotting to kill Jesus. | ||
1215 | MRK | 14 | 1 | gd33 | ἐν δόλῳ | 1 | by stealth | without people noticing | |
1216 | MRK | 14 | 2 | em4q | ἔλεγον γάρ | 1 | For they were saying | The word **they** refers to the chief priests and the scribes. | |
1217 | MRK | 14 | 2 | fk19 | figs-ellipsis | μὴ ἐν τῇ ἑορτῇ | 1 | Not during the festival | This refers to them not arresting Jesus during the Passover **festival**. Alternate translation: “We must not do it during the festival” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1218 | MRK | 14 | 3 | m95w | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Though some were angry that the oil was used to anoint Jesus, Jesus says that the woman has anointed his body for burial before he will die. | ||
1219 | MRK | 14 | 3 | bf84 | translate-names | Σίμωνος τοῦ λεπροῦ | 1 | of Simon the leper | This man previously had leprosy but was no longer ill. This is a different man than Simon Peter and Simon the Zealot. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
1220 | MRK | 14 | 3 | sh4s | κατακειμένου αὐτοῦ | 1 | as he is reclining at table | In Jesus’ culture, when people gathered to eat, they reclined on their sides, propping themselves up on pillows beside a low table. | |
1221 | MRK | 14 | 3 | hk2p | translate-unknown | ἀλάβαστρον | 1 | an alabaster jar | This is a **jar** made from **alabaster**. Alabaster was a very expensive yellow-white stone. Alternate translation: “beautiful white stone jar” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]]) |
1222 | MRK | 14 | 3 | fqa9 | translate-unknown | μύρου, νάρδου πιστικῆς πολυτελοῦς | 1 | of very costly anointing-oil of pure nard | “that contained expensive, fragrant perfume called nard.” Nard was a very expensive, sweet-smelling oil used to make perfume. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]]) |
1223 | MRK | 14 | 3 | tk9r | αὐτοῦ τῆς κεφαλῆς | 1 | his head | “Jesus’ head” | |
1224 | MRK | 14 | 4 | v57p | figs-rquestion | εἰς τί ἡ ἀπώλεια αὕτη τοῦ μύρου γέγονεν? | 1 | For what has this waste of the anointing-oil happened? | They asked this question to show that they disapproved of the woman pouring the perfume on Jesus. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “It is terrible that she wasted that perfume!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1225 | MRK | 14 | 5 | y113 | figs-activepassive | ἠδύνατο…τοῦτο τὸ μύρον πραθῆναι | 1 | this perfume was able to be sold | Mark wants to show his readers that those present were mainly concerned about money. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “we could have sold this perfume” or “she could have sold this perfume” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1226 | MRK | 14 | 5 | t4p8 | translate-bmoney | δηναρίων τριακοσίων | 1 | 300 denarii | Denarii are Roman silver coins. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]]) |
1227 | MRK | 14 | 5 | ciyl | translate-numbers | δηναρίων τριακοσίων | 1 | 300 denarii | “three hundred denarii.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]]) |
1228 | MRK | 14 | 5 | h62k | figs-nominaladj | δοθῆναι τοῖς πτωχοῖς | 1 | given to the poor | The phrase **the poor** refers to poor people. Alternate translation: “given to poor people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]]) |
1229 | MRK | 14 | 5 | k83q | figs-ellipsis | δοθῆναι τοῖς πτωχοῖς | 1 | given to the poor | This refers to giving the money from the sale of the perfume to the poor. Alternate translation: “the money given to poor people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1230 | MRK | 14 | 6 | r9wt | figs-rquestion | τί αὐτῇ κόπους παρέχετε? | 1 | Why are you troubling her? | Jesus rebukes the guests for questioning this woman’s action. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “You should not trouble her!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1231 | MRK | 14 | 7 | tc3j | figs-nominaladj | τοὺς πτωχοὺς | 1 | the poor | This refers to poor people. Alternate translation: “poor people” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]]) |
1232 | MRK | 14 | 9 | vr3w | ἀμὴν…λέγω ὑμῖν | 1 | truly I say to you | This indicates that the statement that follows is especially true and important. See how you translated this in [Mark 3:28](../03/28.md). | |
1233 | MRK | 14 | 9 | ysc5 | figs-activepassive | ὅπου ἐὰν κηρυχθῇ τὸ εὐαγγέλιον | 1 | wherever the gospel may be preached | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “wherever my followers preach the gospel” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1234 | MRK | 14 | 9 | ljh1 | figs-activepassive | καὶ ὃ ἐποίησεν αὕτη, λαληθήσεται | 1 | what she has done will also be spoken of | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “people will speak about what this woman has done” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1235 | MRK | 14 | 10 | pdm5 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After the woman anoints Jesus with perfume, Judas promises to deliver Jesus to the chief priests. | ||
1236 | MRK | 14 | 10 | z71f | figs-explicit | ἵνα αὐτὸν παραδοῖ αὐτοῖς | 1 | so that he might betray him to them | Judas did not deliver Jesus to them yet, rather he went to make arrangements with them. Alternate translation: “in order to arrange with them that he would deliver Jesus over to them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1237 | MRK | 14 | 10 | dq6r | αὐτὸν παραδοῖ | 1 | he might betray him | “he would bring Jesus to them so they could capture him” | |
1238 | MRK | 14 | 11 | kzk1 | figs-explicit | οἱ δὲ ἀκούσαντες | 1 | But when they heard it | It may be helpful to state clearly what the chief priests heard. Alternate translation: “But when the chief priests heard what he was willing to do for them” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1239 | MRK | 14 | 12 | bn76 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus sends two of the disciples to prepare the Passover meal. | ||
1240 | MRK | 14 | 12 | wpe7 | figs-explicit | ὅτε τὸ Πάσχα ἔθυον | 1 | when they were sacrificing the Passover lamb | At the beginning of the Festival of Unleavened Bread, it was customary to sacrifice a lamb. Alternate translation: “when it was customary to sacrifice the Passover lamb” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1241 | MRK | 14 | 12 | bel5 | figs-metonymy | φάγῃς τὸ Πάσχα | 1 | you may eat the Passover | Here the **Passover** refers to the Passover meal. Alternate translation: “eat the Passover meal” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1242 | MRK | 14 | 13 | a7xg | κεράμιον ὕδατος βαστάζων | 1 | bearing a pitcher of water | “carrying a large jar full of water” | |
1243 | MRK | 14 | 14 | i344 | figs-quotations | ὁ διδάσκαλος λέγει, ποῦ ἐστιν τὸ κατάλυμά μου, ὅπου τὸ Πάσχα μετὰ τῶν μαθητῶν μου φάγω? | 1 | The Teacher says, “Where is my guest room where I may eat the Passover with my disciples?” | This can be written as an indirect quote. Translate this so that it is a polite request. Alternate translation: “Our Teacher would like to know where the guest room is where he may eat the Passover with his disciples.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]]) |
1244 | MRK | 14 | 14 | q3pn | τὸ κατάλυμά | 1 | guest room | a room for visitors | |
1245 | MRK | 14 | 15 | x3zk | figs-explicit | ἐκεῖ ἑτοιμάσατε ἡμῖν | 1 | make the preparations for us there | They were to prepare the meal for Jesus and his disciples to eat. Alternate translation: “prepare the meal for us there” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1246 | MRK | 14 | 16 | sb35 | ἐξῆλθον οἱ μαθηταὶ | 1 | the disciples left | “the two disciples left” | |
1247 | MRK | 14 | 16 | m339 | καθὼς εἶπεν | 1 | just as he said | “just as Jesus had said” | |
1248 | MRK | 14 | 17 | n7z4 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | That evening as Jesus and the disciples eat the Passover meal, Jesus tells them that one of them will betray him. | ||
1249 | MRK | 14 | 17 | i1q1 | figs-explicit | ἔρχεται μετὰ τῶν δώδεκα | 1 | he came with the Twelve | It may be helpful to state where they came to. Alternate translation: “he came with the Twelve to the house” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1250 | MRK | 14 | 18 | cwl8 | ἀνακειμένων αὐτῶν | 1 | as they were reclining at table | In Jesus’ culture, when people gathered to eat, they lay down on their sides, propping themselves up on pillows beside a low table. | |
1251 | MRK | 14 | 18 | dg95 | ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν | 1 | Truly I say to you | This indicates that the statement that follows is especially true and important. See how you translated this in [Mark 3:28](../03/28.md). | |
1252 | MRK | 14 | 19 | v3a1 | εἷς κατὰ εἷς | 1 | one by one | This means that “one at a time” each disciple asked him. | |
1253 | MRK | 14 | 19 | f13p | figs-rquestion | μήτι ἐγώ? | 1 | Surely not I? | This could mean: (1) this was a question for which the disciples expected the answer to be no or (2) this was a rhetorical question that did not require a response. Alternate translation: “Surely I am not the one who will betray you!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1254 | MRK | 14 | 20 | b25j | εἷς τῶν δώδεκα | 1 | It is one of the Twelve | “He is one of the twelve of you” | |
1255 | MRK | 14 | 20 | htn4 | ἐμβαπτόμενος μετ’ ἐμοῦ εἰς τὸ τρύβλιον | 1 | who is dipping with me into the bowl | In Jesus’ culture, people would often eat bread, **dipping** it in a shared bowl of sauce or of oil mixed with herbs. | |
1256 | MRK | 14 | 21 | q5l3 | ὅτι ὁ μὲν Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου ὑπάγει, καθὼς γέγραπται περὶ αὐτοῦ | 1 | For the Son of Man is going away just as it has been written about him | Here Jesus refers to the scriptures prophesying about his death. If you have a polite way to talk about death in your language, use it here. Alternate translation: “For the Son of Man will die in the way that the scriptures say” | |
1257 | MRK | 14 | 21 | ct78 | figs-explicit | δι’ οὗ ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου παραδίδοται | 1 | through whom the Son of Man is being betrayed | This can be stated more directly. Alternate translation: “who is betraying the Son of Man” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1258 | MRK | 14 | 22 | y8j7 | ἄρτον | 1 | bread | This was a flat loaf of unleavened **bread**, which was eaten as part of the Passover meal. | |
1259 | MRK | 14 | 22 | ula2 | figs-explicit | ἔκλασεν | 1 | he broke it | This means that he **broke** the bread into pieces for the people to eat. Alternate translation: “broke it into pieces” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1260 | MRK | 14 | 22 | adb2 | writing-symlanguage | λάβετε, τοῦτό ἐστιν τὸ σῶμά μου | 1 | Take this. This is my body | “Take this bread. It is my body.” Though most understand this to mean that the bread is a symbol of Jesus’ **body** and that it is not actual flesh, it is best to translate this statement literally. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-symlanguage]]) |
1261 | MRK | 14 | 23 | u6rc | figs-synecdoche | λαβὼν ποτήριον | 1 | having taken a cup | Here, **cup** is a metonym for wine. Alternate translation: “having taken the cup of wine” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
1262 | MRK | 14 | 24 | q5hn | figs-explicit | τοῦτό ἐστιν τὸ αἷμά μου τῆς διαθήκης, τὸ ἐκχυννόμενον ὑπὲρ πολλῶν | 1 | This is my blood of the covenant, that is being poured out for many | The **covenant** is for the forgiveness of sins. This can be written more explicitly. Alternate translation: “This is my blood that confirms the covenant, the blood that is poured out so that many may receive the forgiveness of sins” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1263 | MRK | 14 | 24 | hs24 | writing-symlanguage | τοῦτό ἐστιν τὸ αἷμά μου | 1 | This is my blood | “This wine is my blood.” Though most understand this to mean that the wine is a symbol of Jesus’ **blood** and that it is not actual blood, it is best to translate this statement literally. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-symlanguage]]) |
1264 | MRK | 14 | 25 | i9yk | ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν | 1 | Truly I say to you | This indicates that the statement that follows is especially true and important. See how you translated this in [Mark 3:28](../03/28.md). | |
1265 | MRK | 14 | 25 | t7ai | ἐκ τοῦ γενήματος τῆς ἀμπέλου | 1 | from the fruit of the vine | “wine.” This is a descriptive way to refer to wine. | |
1266 | MRK | 14 | 25 | y1pf | καινὸν | 1 | new | This could mean: (1) “again” or (2) “in a new way” | |
1267 | MRK | 14 | 26 | l996 | ὑμνήσαντες | 1 | having sung a hymn | A **hymn** is a type of song. It was traditional for them to sing an Old Testament psalm. | |
1268 | MRK | 14 | 27 | pu4s | λέγει αὐτοῖς ὁ Ἰησοῦς | 1 | Jesus says to them | “Jesus said to his disciples” | |
1269 | MRK | 14 | 27 | lty4 | figs-idiom | σκανδαλισθήσεσθε | 1 | will fall away | This is an idiom that means leave. Alternate translation: “will leave me” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1270 | MRK | 14 | 27 | lze6 | πατάξω | 1 | I will strike | “I will kill.” Here, **I** refers to God. | |
1271 | MRK | 14 | 27 | w2az | figs-activepassive | τὰ πρόβατα διασκορπισθήσονται | 1 | the sheep will be scattered | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “I will scatter the sheep” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1272 | MRK | 14 | 28 | lv2u | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Jesus clearly tells Peter he will deny him. Peter and all of the disciples are certain they will not deny Jesus. | ||
1273 | MRK | 14 | 28 | dm1q | figs-idiom | ἐγερθῆναί με | 1 | I am raised up | This idiom means that God will cause Jesus to become alive again after he has died. Alternate translation: “I am made alive again” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1274 | MRK | 14 | 28 | qi4g | figs-activepassive | τὸ ἐγερθῆναί με | 1 | I am raised up | This can be written in active form. Alternate translation: “God raises me from the dead” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1275 | MRK | 14 | 29 | div5 | figs-ellipsis | εἰ καὶ πάντες σκανδαλισθήσονται, ἀλλ’ οὐκ ἐγώ | 1 | Even if all will fall away, yet not I | In the phrase **yet not I**, the words “fall away” are implied Alternate translation: “Even if everyone else leaves you, I will not leave you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1276 | MRK | 14 | 29 | q9dq | figs-doublenegatives | εἰ καὶ πάντες σκανδαλισθήσονται, ἀλλ’ οὐκ ἐγώ | 1 | Even if all will fall away, yet not I | The implied phrase “yet I will not fall away” is a double negative and carries a positive meaning. This can be expressed in the positive if needed. Alternate translation: “Even if everyone else leaves you, I will stay with you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]]) |
1277 | MRK | 14 | 30 | z2q9 | ἀμὴν, λέγω σοι | 1 | Truly I say to you | This indicates that the statement that follows is especially true and important. See how you translated this in [Mark 3:28](../03/28.md). | |
1278 | MRK | 14 | 30 | i4g3 | ἀλέκτορα φωνῆσαι | 1 | the rooster crows | The **rooster** is a bird that calls out very early in the morning. The loud sound he makes is “crowing.” | |
1279 | MRK | 14 | 30 | um1m | σὺ…με ἀπαρνήσῃ | 1 | you will deny me | “you will say that you do not know me” | |
1280 | MRK | 14 | 31 | y9el | ἐὰν δέῃ με συναποθανεῖν | 1 | Even if it is necessary for me to die with | “Even if I must die with” | |
1281 | MRK | 14 | 31 | z9le | ὡσαύτως…καὶ πάντες ἔλεγον | 1 | they all also were speaking in the same manner | This means that all of the disciples said the same thing that Peter said. | |
1282 | MRK | 14 | 32 | ni66 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | When they go to Gethsemane on the Mount of Olives, Jesus encourages three of his disciples to stay awake while he prays. Twice he awakens them, and the third time he tells them to wake up because it is time for the betrayal. | ||
1283 | MRK | 14 | 32 | deg7 | ἔρχονται εἰς χωρίον | 1 | they come to a place | The word **they** refers to Jesus and his disciples. | |
1284 | MRK | 14 | 33 | ps7u | ἐκθαμβεῖσθαι | 1 | to be distressed | to be overwhelmed with sorrow | |
1285 | MRK | 14 | 33 | n279 | figs-metaphor | ἀδημονεῖν | 1 | deeply troubled | The word **deeply** refers to Jesus being greatly troubled in his soul. Alternate translation: “extremely troubled” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1286 | MRK | 14 | 34 | eyw3 | figs-synecdoche | ἐστιν ἡ ψυχή μου | 1 | My soul is | Jesus speaks of himself as his **soul**. Alternate translation: “I am” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
1287 | MRK | 14 | 34 | ic1g | figs-hyperbole | ἕως θανάτου | 1 | even to the point of death | Jesus is exaggerating because he feels so much distress and sorrow that he feels like he is about to die, though he knows he will not die until after the sun rises. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]]) |
1288 | MRK | 14 | 34 | a54k | γρηγορεῖτε | 1 | stay alert | The disciples were to **stay alert** while Jesus prayed. This does not mean that they were supposed to watch Jesus pray. | |
1289 | MRK | 14 | 35 | nk8l | figs-explicit | εἰ δυνατόν ἐστιν | 1 | if it is possible | This means that if God would allow it to happen. Alternate translation: “if God would allow it” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1290 | MRK | 14 | 35 | wc6d | figs-explicit | παρέλθῃ…ἡ ὥρα | 1 | the hour might pass | Here, **the hour** refers to Jesus’ time of suffering, both now in the garden and later. Alternate translation: “that he would not have to go through this time of suffering” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1291 | MRK | 14 | 36 | c11w | translate-transliterate | Ἀββά | 1 | Abba | a term used by Jewish children to address their father. Since it is followed by “Father,” it is best to transliterate this word. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]]) |
1292 | MRK | 14 | 36 | t9r2 | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | ὁ Πατήρ | 1 | Father | This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
1293 | MRK | 14 | 36 | jk6a | figs-metonymy | παρένεγκε τὸ ποτήριον τοῦτο ἀπ’ ἐμοῦ | 1 | Remove this cup from me | Jesus speaks of the suffering that he must endure as if it were a **cup**. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1294 | MRK | 14 | 36 | ha77 | figs-ellipsis | ἀλλ’ οὐ τί ἐγὼ θέλω, ἀλλὰ τί σύ | 1 | But not what I will, but what you will | Jesus is asking God to do what he wants to be done and not what Jesus wants. Alternate translation: “But do not do what I want, do what you want” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1295 | MRK | 14 | 37 | ja6d | εὑρίσκει αὐτοὺς καθεύδοντας | 1 | finds them sleeping | The word **them** refers to Peter, James, and John. | |
1296 | MRK | 14 | 37 | kp33 | figs-rquestion | Σίμων, καθεύδεις? οὐκ ἴσχυσας μίαν ὥραν γρηγορῆσαι? | 1 | Simon, are you asleep? Were you not able to stay alert for one hour? | Jesus rebukes Simon Peter for sleeping. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “Simon, you are asleep when I told you to stay awake. You could not even stay awake for one hour.” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1297 | MRK | 14 | 38 | zrp4 | figs-metaphor | ἵνα μὴ ἔλθητε εἰς πειρασμόν | 1 | so that you may not enter into temptation | Jesus speaks of being tempted as if it were entering into a physical place. Alternate translation: “so that you may not be tempted” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1298 | MRK | 14 | 38 | xk5y | τὸ μὲν πνεῦμα πρόθυμον, ἡ δὲ σὰρξ ἀσθενής | 1 | The spirit indeed is willing, but the flesh is weak | Jesus warns Simon Peter that he is not strong enough to do what he wants to do in his own strength. Alternate translation: “You are willing in your spirit, but you are too weak to do what you want to do” or “You want to do what I say, but you are weak” | |
1299 | MRK | 14 | 38 | c1je | figs-metonymy | τὸ…πνεῦμα…ἡ…σὰρξ | 1 | The spirit … the flesh | These refer to two different aspects of Peter. Here, the **spirit** is his inmost desires and the **flesh** is his human ability and strength. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1300 | MRK | 14 | 39 | l9nj | τὸν αὐτὸν λόγον εἰπών | 1 | having said the same thing | “having prayed again what he prayed before” | |
1301 | MRK | 14 | 40 | v49m | εὗρεν αὐτοὺς καθεύδοντας | 1 | he found them sleeping | The word **them** refers to Peter, James, and John. | |
1302 | MRK | 14 | 40 | ht2p | figs-metaphor | ἦσαν γὰρ αὐτῶν οἱ ὀφθαλμοὶ καταβαρυνόμενοι | 1 | for their eyes were weighed down | Here the author speaks of a sleepy person having a hard time keeping his eyes open as having **eyes** that are **weighed down**. Alternate translation: “for they were so sleepy they were having a hard time keeping their eyes open” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1303 | MRK | 14 | 41 | x7qd | figs-explicit | ἔρχεται τὸ τρίτον | 1 | he comes the third time | Jesus had gone and prayed again. Then he returned to them a **third time**. This can be made clear. Alternate translation: “he went and prayed again. He returned the third time” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1304 | MRK | 14 | 41 | lw7w | figs-rquestion | καθεύδετε τὸ λοιπὸν καὶ ἀναπαύεσθε. | 1 | Are you still sleeping and resting? | Jesus rebukes his disciples for not staying awake and praying. You can translate this rhetorical question as a statement if needed. Alternate translation: “You are still sleeping and resting!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1305 | MRK | 14 | 41 | ae53 | ἦλθεν ἡ ὥρα | 1 | The hour has come | The time of Jesus’ suffering and betrayal is about to begin. | |
1306 | MRK | 14 | 41 | msb2 | ἰδοὺ | 1 | Behold | “Listen” | |
1307 | MRK | 14 | 41 | eg9m | figs-activepassive | παραδίδοται ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου | 1 | the Son of Man is being betrayed | Jesus warns his disciples that his betrayer is approaching them. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “someone is betraying me, the Son of Man” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1308 | MRK | 14 | 43 | r9cp | writing-background | 0 | General Information: | Verse 44 gives background information about how Judas had arranged with the Jewish leaders to betray Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) | |
1309 | MRK | 14 | 43 | nz4t | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Judas betrays Jesus with a kiss, and the disciples all flee. | ||
1310 | MRK | 14 | 44 | bzj2 | δὲ ὁ παραδιδοὺς αὐτὸν | 1 | And his betrayer | This refers to Judas. | |
1311 | MRK | 14 | 44 | lsh3 | figs-explicit | αὐτός ἐστιν | 1 | he it is | This refers to the man that Judas was going to identify. Alternate translation: “he is the one you want” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1312 | MRK | 14 | 45 | tpd4 | κατεφίλησεν αὐτόν | 1 | he kissed him | “Judas kissed him” | |
1313 | MRK | 14 | 46 | y5qv | figs-parallelism | ἐπέβαλαν τὰς χεῖρας αὐτῶν καὶ ἐκράτησαν αὐτόν | 1 | laid hands on him and seized him | These two phrases have the same meaning to emphasize that they seized Jesus. Alternate translation: “grabbed Jesus and seized him” or “seized him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]]) |
1314 | MRK | 14 | 47 | m6b9 | τῶν παρεστηκότων | 1 | of those standing by | “of the people who were standing nearby” | |
1315 | MRK | 14 | 48 | gv6e | ἀποκριθεὶς ὁ Ἰησοῦς εἶπεν αὐτοῖς | 1 | answering, Jesus said to them | “Jesus said to the crowd” | |
1316 | MRK | 14 | 48 | eq25 | figs-rquestion | ὡς ἐπὶ λῃστὴν ἐξήλθατε μετὰ μαχαιρῶν καὶ ξύλων συνλαβεῖν με? | 1 | Did you come out, as against a robber, with swords and clubs to seize me? | Jesus is rebuking the crowd. This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “It is ridiculous that you come here to seize me with swords and clubs, as if I were a robber!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1317 | MRK | 14 | 49 | s63a | ἀλλ’ ἵνα | 1 | But so that | “But this has happened so that” | |
1318 | MRK | 14 | 50 | gqz8 | ἔφυγον πάντες | 1 | they all ran away | This refers to the disciples. | |
1319 | MRK | 14 | 51 | y5yt | σινδόνα | 1 | a linen garment | a cloth made from the fibers of a flax plant | |
1320 | MRK | 14 | 51 | nag4 | κρατοῦσιν αὐτόν | 1 | they seize him | “the men seized that man” | |
1321 | MRK | 14 | 52 | eud7 | ὁ δὲ καταλιπὼν τὴν σινδόνα | 1 | but he, having left behind the linen garment | As the man was trying to run away, the others would have grabbed at his clothing, trying to stop him. | |
1322 | MRK | 14 | 53 | qu33 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | After the crowd of the chief priests, scribes, and elders lead Jesus to the high priest, Peter watches nearby while some stand to give false testimony against Jesus. | ||
1323 | MRK | 14 | 53 | s7t1 | συνέρχονται πάντες οἱ ἀρχιερεῖς, καὶ οἱ πρεσβύτεροι, καὶ οἱ γραμματεῖς | 1 | all the chief priests, and the elders, and the scribes gather together | This can be reordered so that it is easier to understand. “all of the chief priests, the elders, and the scribes had gathered there together” | |
1324 | MRK | 14 | 54 | bzg7 | καὶ | 1 | Now | This word is used here to mark a shift in the story line as the author begins telling us about Peter. | |
1325 | MRK | 14 | 54 | l5gl | figs-explicit | ἕως ἔσω εἰς τὴν αὐλὴν τοῦ ἀρχιερέως | 1 | as far as into the courtyard of the high priest | As Peter followed Jesus, he stopped at the high priest’s courtyard. This can be written clearly. Alternate translation: “and he all the way to the courtyard of the high priest” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1326 | MRK | 14 | 54 | x2g5 | figs-explicit | ἦν συνκαθήμενος μετὰ τῶν ὑπηρετῶν | 1 | he was sitting with the guards | Peter sat with the guards who were working at the courtyard. Alternate translation: “he sat in the courtyard among the guards” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1327 | MRK | 14 | 55 | w23n | δὲ | 1 | Now | This word is used here to mark a shift in the story line as the author continues telling us about Jesus being put on trial. | |
1328 | MRK | 14 | 55 | fu1l | figs-metonymy | εἰς τὸ θανατῶσαι αὐτόν | 1 | to put him to death | They were not the ones who would execute Jesus; rather, they would order someone else to do it. Alternate translation: “so they might have someone execute Jesus” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1329 | MRK | 14 | 55 | d9gn | figs-explicit | οὐχ ηὕρισκον | 1 | they were not finding any | They did not find testimony against Jesus with which they could convict him and have him put to death. Alternate translation: “they did not find any testimony with which to convict him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1330 | MRK | 14 | 56 | jpc7 | ἴσαι αἱ μαρτυρίαι οὐκ ἦσαν | 1 | their testimony was not the same | This can be written in positive form. “but their testimony contradicted each other” | |
1331 | MRK | 14 | 58 | f82e | figs-exclusive | ἡμεῖς ἠκούσαμεν αὐτοῦ λέγοντος | 1 | We heard him saying | “We heard Jesus say.” The word **We** refers to the people who falsely testified against Jesus and does not include the people to whom they are speaking. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]]) |
1332 | MRK | 14 | 58 | e94y | figs-synecdoche | τὸν χειροποίητον…ἀχειροποίητον | 1 | made with hands … made without hands | Here, **hands** refers to men. Alternate translation: “made by men … made without man’s help” or “built by men … built without man’s help” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]]) |
1333 | MRK | 14 | 58 | k1vs | διὰ τριῶν ἡμερῶν | 1 | in three days | “within three days.” This means that the temple would be built within a three-day period. | |
1334 | MRK | 14 | 58 | hm5e | figs-ellipsis | ἄλλον…οἰκοδομήσω | 1 | I will build another | The word “temple” is understood from the previous phrase. It may be repeated. Alternate translation: “I will build another temple” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1335 | MRK | 14 | 59 | x6hk | οὐδὲ οὕτως ἴση ἦν ἡ μαρτυρία αὐτῶν | 1 | not even in this manner was their testimony the same | “even then what they testified contradicted each other.” This can be written in positive form. | |
1336 | MRK | 14 | 60 | d7i8 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | When Jesus answers that he is the Christ, the high priest and all of the leaders there condemn him as one who deserves to die. | ||
1337 | MRK | 14 | 60 | q2u1 | figs-explicit | ἀναστὰς…εἰς μέσον | 1 | having stood up in their midst | Jesus stands up in the middle of the angry crowd to speak to them. Translate this to show who was present when Jesus stood in their midst. Alternate translation: “stood up among the chief priests, scribes, and elders” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1338 | MRK | 14 | 60 | af5e | figs-explicit | οὐκ ἀποκρίνῃ οὐδέν? τί οὗτοί σου καταμαρτυροῦσιν? | 1 | Do you not answer at all? What are these testifying against you? | The chief priest is not asking Jesus for information about what the witnesses said. He is asking Jesus to prove what the witnesses said is wrong. Alternate translation: “Are you not going to reply? What do you say in response to the testimony these men are speaking against you?” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1339 | MRK | 14 | 61 | x6ey | figs-nominaladj | τοῦ Εὐλογητοῦ | 1 | of the Blessed One | Here God is called **the Blessed One**. Alternate translation: “of God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]]) |
1340 | MRK | 14 | 61 | o27t | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Εὐλογητοῦ | 1 | the Son of the Blessed One | It is best to translate **Son** with the same word your language would naturally use to refer to a “son” of a human father. Alternate translation: “the Son of the Blessed One” or “the Son of God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
1341 | MRK | 14 | 62 | z5rv | ἐγώ εἰμι | 1 | I am | This likely has a double meaning: (1) to respond to the high priest’s question and (2) to call himself “I Am,” which is what God called himself in the Old Testament. | |
1342 | MRK | 14 | 62 | e1xd | figs-metonymy | ἐκ δεξιῶν καθήμενον τῆς δυνάμεως | 1 | sitting at the right hand of power | Here, **power** is a metonym that represents God. Alternate translation: “sitting at the right hand of God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1343 | MRK | 14 | 62 | d5qm | translate-symaction | ἐκ δεξιῶν καθήμενον τῆς δυνάμεως | 1 | sitting at the right hand of power | To sit **at the right hand** of God is a symbolic action of receiving great honor and authority from God. Alternate translation: “he sits in the place of honor beside the all-powerful God” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]]) |
1344 | MRK | 14 | 62 | z55c | figs-metaphor | ἐρχόμενον μετὰ τῶν νεφελῶν τοῦ οὐρανοῦ | 1 | coming with the clouds of heaven | Here the **clouds** are described as accompanying Jesus when he returns. Alternate translation: “when he comes down through the clouds in the sky” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1345 | MRK | 14 | 63 | jz48 | διαρρήξας τοὺς χιτῶνας αὐτοῦ | 1 | having torn his garments | The high priest tore his clothes purposefully to show his outrage and horror at what Jesus had said. Alternate translation: “having torn his garments in outrage” | |
1346 | MRK | 14 | 63 | afd3 | figs-rquestion | τί ἔτι χρείαν ἔχομεν μαρτύρων? | 1 | What need do we still have of witnesses? | This can be written as a statement. Alternate translation: “We certainly do not need any more people who will testify against this man!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]]) |
1347 | MRK | 14 | 64 | zwf9 | figs-explicit | ἠκούσατε τῆς βλασφημίας | 1 | You heard the blasphemy | This refers to what Jesus said, which the high priest called blasphemy. Alternate translation: “You have heard the blasphemy he has spoken” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1348 | MRK | 14 | 64 | fu4g | οἱ…πάντες | 1 | they all | all the people in the room | |
1349 | MRK | 14 | 65 | y1s4 | ἤρξαντό τινες | 1 | certain ones began | some of the people in the room started | |
1350 | MRK | 14 | 65 | bj5e | figs-explicit | περικαλύπτειν αὐτοῦ τὸ πρόσωπον | 1 | to cover his face | They covered his face with a cloth or blindfold, so he could not see. Alternate translation: “to cover his face with a blindfold” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1351 | MRK | 14 | 65 | gvq3 | figs-explicit | προφήτευσον | 1 | Prophesy | They mocked him, asking him to tell them who was hitting him. Alternate translation: “Prophesy who hit you” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1352 | MRK | 14 | 65 | y68i | οἱ ὑπηρέται | 1 | the officers | the men who guarded the governor’s house | |
1353 | MRK | 14 | 66 | fj8d | 0 | Connecting Statement: | As Jesus had predicted, Peter denies Jesus three times before the rooster crows. | ||
1354 | MRK | 14 | 66 | m8g8 | κάτω ἐν τῇ αὐλῇ | 1 | below in the courtyard | “outside in the courtyard” | |
1355 | MRK | 14 | 66 | t2mx | figs-explicit | μία τῶν παιδισκῶν τοῦ ἀρχιερέως | 1 | one of the servant girls of the high priest | The **servant girls** worked for the **high priest**. Alternate translation: “one of the servant girls who worked for the high priest” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1356 | MRK | 14 | 68 | l5i1 | ἠρνήσατο | 1 | denied it | This means to claim that something is not true. In this case, Peter was saying that what the servant girl said about him was not true. | |
1357 | MRK | 14 | 68 | d3ch | figs-doublet | οὔτε οἶδα, οὔτε ἐπίσταμαι σὺ τί λέγεις | 1 | Neither have I known nor do I understand what you are saying | Both **have I known** and **I understand** have the same meaning here. The meaning is repeated to add emphasis to what Peter is saying. Alternate translation: “I really do not understand what you are talking about” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]]) |
1358 | MRK | 14 | 69 | l137 | ἡ παιδίσκη | 1 | the servant girl | This is the same servant girl who identified Peter previously. | |
1359 | MRK | 14 | 69 | v5kr | figs-explicit | οὗτος ἐξ αὐτῶν ἐστιν | 1 | This one is from among them | The people were identifying Peter as one of Jesus’ disciples. This can be made more clear. Alternate translation: “This one is one of Jesus’ disciples” or “This is one of those who have been with that man they arrested” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1360 | MRK | 14 | 71 | ce6r | figs-idiom | ἀναθεματίζειν | 1 | to curse | If in your language you have to name the person who curses someone, state God. Alternate translation: “to say for God to curse him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1361 | MRK | 14 | 72 | i7u2 | εὐθὺς…ἀλέκτωρ ἐφώνησεν | 1 | immediately a rooster crowed | A **rooster** is a bird that calls out very early in the morning. The loud sound he makes is “crowing.” | |
1362 | MRK | 14 | 72 | ja3e | translate-ordinal | ἐκ δευτέρου | 1 | a second time | Here, **second** is an ordinal number. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]]) |
1363 | MRK | 14 | 72 | zr4p | figs-idiom | ἐπιβαλὼν | 1 | having broken down | This idiom means that he was overwhelmed with grief and lost control of his emotions. Alternate translation: “he was overwhelmed with grief” or “he lost control of his emotions” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]]) |
1364 | MRK | 15 | intro | d823 | 0 | # Mark 15 General Notes<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### “The curtain of the temple was split in two”<br><br>The curtain in the temple was an important symbol that showed that people needed to have someone speak to God for them. They could not speak to God directly because all people are sinful and God hates sin. God split the curtain to show that Jesus’ people can now speak to God directly because Jesus has paid for their sins.<br><br>### The tomb<br><br>The tomb in which Jesus was buried ([Mark 15:46](../../mrk/15/46.md)) was the kind of tomb in which wealthy Jewish families buried their dead. It was an actual room cut into a rock. It had a flat place on one side where they could place the body after they had put oil and spices on it and wrapped it in cloth. Then they would roll a large rock in front of the tomb so no one could see inside or enter.<br><br>## Important figures of speech in this chapter<br><br>### Sarcasm<br><br>Both by pretending to worship Jesus ([Mark 15:19](../../mrk/15/19.md)) and by pretending to speak to a king ([Mark 15:18](../../mrk/15/18.md)), the soldiers and the Jews showed that they hated Jesus and did not believe that he was the Son of God. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]] and [[rc://en/tw/dict/bible/other/mock]])<br><br>## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter<br><br>### Eloi, Eloi, lama sabachthani?<br><br>This is a phrase in Aramaic. Mark transliterates its sounds by writing them using Greek letters. He then explains its meaning. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]]) | |||
1365 | MRK | 15 | 1 | mps2 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | When the chief priests, the elders, the scribes, and the council gave Jesus over to Pilate, they accused Jesus of doing many bad things. When Pilate asked if what they said was true, Jesus did not answer him. | ||
1366 | MRK | 15 | 1 | xz7c | figs-metonymy | δήσαντες τὸν Ἰησοῦν, ἀπήνεγκαν | 1 | having bound Jesus, led him away | They commanded for Jesus to be **bound**, but it would have been the guards who actually bound him and **led him away**. Alternate translation: “commanded the guards to bind Jesus and then they led him away” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1367 | MRK | 15 | 1 | v2yf | παρέδωκαν Πειλάτῳ | 1 | handed him over to Pilate | They had Jesus led to Pilate and transferred control of Jesus over to him. | |
1368 | MRK | 15 | 2 | dh6n | figs-explicit | σὺ λέγεις | 1 | You say so | This could mean: (1) Jesus was saying that Pilate, not Jesus, was the one calling him the King of the Jews. Alternate translation: “You yourself have said so” or (2) Jesus implied that he is the King of the Jews. Alternate translation: “Yes, as you said, I am” or “Yes. It is as you said” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1369 | MRK | 15 | 3 | ue18 | κατηγόρουν αὐτοῦ…πολλά | 1 | were accusing him of many things | “were accusing Jesus of many things” or “were saying that Jesus had done many bad things” | |
1370 | MRK | 15 | 4 | c9uc | ὁ δὲ Πειλᾶτος πάλιν ἐπηρώτα αὐτὸν | 1 | But Pilate again was questioning him | “But Pilate asked Jesus again” | |
1371 | MRK | 15 | 4 | s2as | οὐκ ἀποκρίνῃ οὐδέν? | 1 | Do you not answer at all? | This can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “Do you have an answer?” | |
1372 | MRK | 15 | 4 | pm6k | ἴδε | 1 | See | “Look at” or “Listen to” or “Pay attention to” | |
1373 | MRK | 15 | 5 | way9 | ὥστε θαυμάζειν τὸν Πειλᾶτον | 1 | so that Pilate was amazed | It surprised **Pilate** that Jesus did not reply and defend himself. | |
1374 | MRK | 15 | 6 | ul5e | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Pilate, hoping the crowd will choose Jesus, offers to release a prisoner, but the crowd asks for Barabbas instead. | ||
1375 | MRK | 15 | 6 | ul19 | writing-background | δὲ | 1 | Now | This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line as the author shifts to telling background information about Pilate’s tradition of releasing a prisoner at feasts and about Barabbas. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) |
1376 | MRK | 15 | 7 | fa7t | ἦν δὲ ὁ λεγόμενος Βαραββᾶς, μετὰ τῶν στασιαστῶν δεδεμένος | 1 | And there was, bound with the rebels, one who was called Barabbas | “At that time there was a man called Barabbas, who was in prison with some other men” | |
1377 | MRK | 15 | 8 | a4xb | figs-explicit | αἰτεῖσθαι καθὼς ἐποίει αὐτοῖς | 1 | to request of him just as he usually did for them | This refers to Pilate releasing a prisoner at feasts. This can be made clear. Alternate translation: “to ask him to release a prisoner to them as he had done in the past” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1378 | MRK | 15 | 10 | i4ib | writing-background | ἐγίνωσκεν γὰρ ὅτι διὰ φθόνον παραδεδώκεισαν αὐτὸν οἱ ἀρχιερεῖς | 1 | For he knew that the chief priests had handed him over because of envy | This is background information about why Jesus was **handed over** to Pilate. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) |
1379 | MRK | 15 | 10 | u647 | figs-explicit | διὰ φθόνον παραδεδώκεισαν αὐτὸν οἱ ἀρχιερεῖς | 1 | the chief priests had handed him over because of envy | They **chief priests** envied Jesus, probably because so many people were following him and becoming his disciples. Alternate translation: “the chief priests were envious of Jesus. This is why they handed him over” or “the chief priests were envious of Jesus’ popularity among the people. This is why they handed him over” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1380 | MRK | 15 | 11 | y5w3 | figs-metaphor | ἀνέσεισαν τὸν ὄχλον | 1 | stirred up the crowd | The author speaks of the chief priests rousing or urging **the crowd** as if the crowd were a bowl of something that they were stirring. Alternate translation: “roused the crowd” or “urged the crowd” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1381 | MRK | 15 | 11 | pvu6 | figs-ellipsis | μᾶλλον τὸν Βαραββᾶν ἀπολύσῃ αὐτοῖς | 1 | he would release Barabbas to them instead | They requested Pilate to **release Barabbas** **instead** of Jesus. Alternate translation: “he would release Barabbas instead of Jesus” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]]) |
1382 | MRK | 15 | 12 | keq2 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | The crowd asks for Jesus’ death, so Pilate turns him over to the soldiers, who mock him, crown him with thorns, strike him, and lead him out to crucify him. | ||
1383 | MRK | 15 | 12 | vlm3 | figs-explicit | τί οὖν ποιήσω λέγετε τὸν Βασιλέα τῶν Ἰουδαίων? | 1 | What therefore should I do to the one you call the King of the Jews? | Pilate asks what he should do with Jesus if he releases Barabbas to them. This can be written clearly. Alternate translation: “If I release Barabbas, what then should I do with the King of the Jews?” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1384 | MRK | 15 | 14 | e55i | ὁ δὲ Πειλᾶτος ἔλεγεν αὐτοῖς | 1 | But Pilate was saying to them | “But Pilate said to the crowd” | |
1385 | MRK | 15 | 15 | qt8y | τῷ ὄχλῳ τὸ ἱκανὸν ποιῆσαι | 1 | to do what was pleasing to the crowd | “to make the crowd happy by doing what they wanted him to do” | |
1386 | MRK | 15 | 15 | fwg6 | τὸν Ἰησοῦν φραγελλώσας | 1 | Jesus, having flogged him | Pilate did not actually scourge **Jesus**, but rather his soldiers did. | |
1387 | MRK | 15 | 15 | yzn5 | φραγελλώσας | 1 | having flogged him | “having whipped him.” To **flog** is to beat with an especially painful whip. | |
1388 | MRK | 15 | 15 | r9id | figs-activepassive | παρέδωκεν τὸν Ἰησοῦν φραγελλώσας, ἵνα σταυρωθῇ | 1 | handed over Jesus, having flogged him, so that he might be crucified | Pilate told his soldiers to take **Jesus** away to crucify him. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “told his soldiers to take him away and crucify him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1389 | MRK | 15 | 16 | eg6x | τῆς αὐλῆς, ὅ ἐστιν πραιτώριον | 1 | the palace (that is, the Praetorium) | This was where the Roman soldiers in Jerusalem lived, and where the governor stayed when he was in Jerusalem. Alternate translation: “the courtyard of the soldiers’ barracks” or “the courtyard of the governor’s residence” | |
1390 | MRK | 15 | 16 | b5gs | ὅλην τὴν σπεῖραν | 1 | the whole cohort of soldiers | “the whole unit of soldiers” | |
1391 | MRK | 15 | 17 | tn33 | ἐνδιδύσκουσιν αὐτὸν πορφύραν | 1 | They put a purple robe on him | Purple was a color worn by royalty. The soldiers did not believe that Jesus was king. They clothed him this way to mock him because others said that he was the King of the Jews. | |
1392 | MRK | 15 | 17 | xfk8 | ἀκάνθινον στέφανον | 1 | a crown of thorns | “a crown made of thorny branches” | |
1393 | MRK | 15 | 18 | ft1j | figs-irony | Χαῖρε, Βασιλεῦ τῶν Ἰουδαίων | 1 | Hail, King of the Jews | The greeting “Hail” with a raised hand was only used to greet the Roman emperor. The soldiers did not believe that Jesus was the king of the Jews. Rather they said this to mock him. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]]) |
1394 | MRK | 15 | 19 | gz3b | καλάμῳ | 1 | a reed | “a stick” or “a staff” | |
1395 | MRK | 15 | 19 | a8a9 | figs-metaphor | τιθέντες τὰ γόνατα | 1 | They knelt down | A person who kneels bends his knees, so those who kneel are sometimes said to “bend their knees.” Alternate translation: “kneeled” or “knelt” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1396 | MRK | 15 | 21 | cj4l | ἀγγαρεύουσιν…ἵνα ἄρῃ τὸν σταυρὸν αὐτοῦ | 1 | they forced him to carry his cross | According to Roman law, a solider could force a man he came upon along the road to carry a load. In this case, they forced Simon to carry Jesus’ cross. | |
1397 | MRK | 15 | 21 | s4j3 | ἀπ’ ἀγροῦ | 1 | from the country | “from outside the city” | |
1398 | MRK | 15 | 21 | cyn6 | writing-background | ἀγγαρεύουσιν, παράγοντά τινα Σίμωνα Κυρηναῖον, ἐρχόμενον ἀπ’ ἀγροῦ, τὸν πατέρα Ἀλεξάνδρου καὶ Ῥούφου | 1 | they pressed into service a certain passerby, Simon of Cyrene (the father of Alexander and Rufus), coming from the country | This is background information about the man whom the soldiers forced to carry Jesus’ cross. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) |
1399 | MRK | 15 | 21 | rtz2 | translate-names | Σίμωνα…Ἀλεξάνδρου…Ῥούφου | 1 | Simon…Alexander…Rufus | These are names of men. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
1400 | MRK | 15 | 21 | py16 | translate-names | Κυρηναῖον | 1 | Cyrene | This is the name of a place. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
1401 | MRK | 15 | 22 | w6c7 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | The soldiers bring Jesus to Golgotha, where they crucify him with two others. Many people mock him. | ||
1402 | MRK | 15 | 22 | e49p | translate-names | Κρανίου Τόπος | 1 | Place of a Skull | “Skull Place” or “Place of the Skull.” This the name of a place. It does not mean that there are lots of skulls there. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
1403 | MRK | 15 | 22 | m1dd | Κρανίου | 1 | of a Skull | A **Skull** is the head bones, or a head without any flesh on it. | |
1404 | MRK | 15 | 23 | e9xd | figs-explicit | ἐσμυρνισμένον οἶνον | 1 | wine having been mixed with myrrh | It may be helpful to explain that **myrrh** is a pain-relieving medicine. Alternate translation: “wine mixed with a medicine called myrrh” or “wine mixed with a pain-relieving medicine called myrrh” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1405 | MRK | 15 | 25 | q1ze | translate-ordinal | ὥρα τρίτη | 1 | the third hour | Here, **third** here is a ordinal number. This refers to nine o’clock in the morning. Alternate translation: “nine o’clock in the morning” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]]) |
1406 | MRK | 15 | 26 | b84a | τῆς αἰτίας αὐτοῦ ἐπιγεγραμμένη | 1 | of the charge having been written against him | “of the crime they were accusing him of doing” | |
1407 | MRK | 15 | 27 | mgf3 | figs-explicit | ἕνα ἐκ δεξιῶν καὶ ἕνα ἐξ εὐωνύμων αὐτοῦ | 1 | one on his right, and one on his left | This can be written more clearly. Alternate translation: “one on a cross on the right side of him and one on a cross on the left side of him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1408 | MRK | 15 | 29 | v8nu | translate-symaction | κινοῦντες τὰς κεφαλὰς αὐτῶν | 1 | shaking their heads | This is an action people do to show that they disapproved of Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]]) |
1409 | MRK | 15 | 29 | a7ft | figs-exclamations | οὐὰ | 1 | Aha! | This is a exclamation of mockery. Use the appropriate exclamation in your language. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-exclamations]]) |
1410 | MRK | 15 | 29 | hy37 | figs-explicit | ὁ καταλύων τὸν ναὸν καὶ οἰκοδομῶν ἐν τρισὶν ἡμέραις | 1 | The one destroying the temple and rebuilding it in three days | The people refer to Jesus by what he earlier prophesied that he would do. Alternate translation: “You who said you would destroy the temple and rebuild it in three days” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1411 | MRK | 15 | 31 | n13x | ὁμοίως | 1 | In the same way | This refers to the way that the people who were walking by Jesus were mocking him. | |
1412 | MRK | 15 | 31 | d5se | ἐμπαίζοντες πρὸς ἀλλήλους | 1 | mocking him to each other | “were saying mocking things about Jesus among themselves” | |
1413 | MRK | 15 | 32 | t1vm | figs-irony | ὁ Χριστὸς, ὁ Βασιλεὺς Ἰσραὴλ καταβάτω | 1 | Let the Christ, the King of Israel, come down | The leaders did not believe that Jesus is **the Christ, the King of Israel**. Alternate translation: “He calls himself the Christ and the King of Israel. So let him come down” or “If he is really the Christ and the King of Israel, he should come down” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]]) |
1414 | MRK | 15 | 32 | r6c4 | figs-explicit | πιστεύσωμεν | 1 | might believe | The means to believe in Jesus. Alternate translation: “believe in him” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1415 | MRK | 15 | 32 | dcb9 | ὠνείδιζον | 1 | were taunting | mocking, insulting | |
1416 | MRK | 15 | 33 | zc37 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | At noon darkness covers the whole land until three o’clock, when Jesus cries out with a loud voice and dies. When Jesus dies, the temple curtain rips from the top to the bottom. | ||
1417 | MRK | 15 | 33 | q1gh | ὥρας ἕκτης | 1 | the sixth hour | This refers to noon or 12 p.m. | |
1418 | MRK | 15 | 33 | jl1i | figs-metaphor | σκότος ἐγένετο ἐφ’ ὅλην τὴν γῆν | 1 | darkness came over the whole land | Here the author describes it becoming dark outside as if the **darkness** were a wave that moved over the **land**. Alternate translation: “the whole land became dark” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1419 | MRK | 15 | 34 | r6tj | τῇ ἐνάτῃ ὥρᾳ | 1 | at the ninth hour | This refers to three o’clock in the afternoon. Alternate translation: “at three o’clock in the afternoon” or “in the middle of the afternoon” | |
1420 | MRK | 15 | 34 | ls1n | translate-transliterate | Ἐλωῒ, Ἐλωῒ, λεμὰ σαβαχθάνει | 1 | Eloi, Eloi, lama sabachthani | These are Aramaic words that should be copied as is into your language with similar sounds. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]]) |
1421 | MRK | 15 | 34 | qw71 | ἐστιν μεθερμηνευόμενον | 1 | is translated | “means” | |
1422 | MRK | 15 | 35 | apg3 | figs-explicit | καί τινες τῶν παρεστηκότων, ἀκούσαντες ἔλεγον | 1 | And some of those who had been standing by, having heard him, were saying | It can be stated clearly that they misunderstood what Jesus said. Alternate translation: “When some of those standing there heard his words, they misunderstood and said” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1423 | MRK | 15 | 36 | a8qx | ὄξους | 1 | with sour wine | “with vinegar” | |
1424 | MRK | 15 | 36 | un73 | καλάμῳ | 1 | a reed | “a stick.” This was a staff made from a reed. | |
1425 | MRK | 15 | 36 | yb55 | figs-explicit | ἐπότιζεν αὐτόν | 1 | was giving it to him to drink | “was giving it to Jesus.” The man held up the staff so that Jesus could drink wine from the sponge. Alternate translation: “held it up to Jesus” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1426 | MRK | 15 | 38 | ni8j | figs-activepassive | τὸ καταπέτασμα τοῦ ναοῦ ἐσχίσθη εἰς δύο | 1 | the curtain of the temple was torn in two | Mark is showing that God himself split **the curtain of the temple**. This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “God split the curtain of the temple in two” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1427 | MRK | 15 | 39 | lg4u | ὁ κεντυρίων | 1 | the centurion | This is **the centurion** who supervised the soldiers who crucified Jesus. | |
1428 | MRK | 15 | 39 | y4wn | ὁ παρεστηκὼς ἐξ ἐναντίας αὐτοῦ | 1 | who had stood in front of him | “who stood in front of Jesus” | |
1429 | MRK | 15 | 39 | t828 | ὅτι οὕτως ἐξέπνευσεν | 1 | that he had breathed his last in this way | “how Jesus had died” or “the way Jesus had died” | |
1430 | MRK | 15 | 39 | nqv8 | guidelines-sonofgodprinciples | Υἱὸς Θεοῦ | 1 | the Son of God | This is an important title for Jesus. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]]) |
1431 | MRK | 15 | 40 | i1ee | ἀπὸ μακρόθεν θεωροῦσαι | 1 | looking on from a distance | “watching from far away” | |
1432 | MRK | 15 | 40 | zc9b | ἡ Ἰακώβου τοῦ μικροῦ καὶ Ἰωσῆ μήτηρ | 1 | (the mother of James the younger and of Joses) | This can be written without the parentheses. Alternate translation: “who was the mother of James the younger and of Joses” | |
1433 | MRK | 15 | 40 | p9xk | Ἰακώβου τοῦ μικροῦ | 1 | of James the younger | “of the younger James.” This man was referred to as **the younger** probably to distinguish him from another man named James. | |
1434 | MRK | 15 | 40 | izn7 | translate-names | Ἰωσῆ | 1 | of Joses | This **Joses** was not that same person as the younger brother of Jesus. See how you translated the same name in [Mark 6:3](../06/03.md). (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
1435 | MRK | 15 | 40 | tw5s | translate-names | Σαλώμη | 1 | Salome | **Salome** is the name of a woman. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
1436 | MRK | 15 | 41 | j15z | writing-background | αἳ ὅτε ἦν ἐν τῇ Γαλιλαίᾳ ἠκολούθουν αὐτῷ καὶ διηκόνουν αὐτῷ, καὶ ἄλλαι πολλαὶ αἱ συναναβᾶσαι αὐτῷ εἰς Ἱεροσόλυμα | 1 | When he was in Galilee they were following him and serving him, and many other women who had come up with him to Jerusalem | “When Jesus was in Galilee these women followed him and served him, along with many other women who had come up with him to Jerusalem.” This is background information about the women who watched the crucifixion from a distance. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) |
1437 | MRK | 15 | 41 | a3qk | συναναβᾶσαι αὐτῷ εἰς Ἱεροσόλυμα | 1 | who had come up with him to Jerusalem | **Jerusalem** was higher than almost any other place in Israel, so it was normal for people to speak of going **up** to Jerusalem and going down from it. | |
1438 | MRK | 15 | 42 | lxm5 | 0 | Connecting Statement: | Joseph of Arimathea asks Pilate for the body of Jesus, which he wraps in linen and puts in a tomb. | ||
1439 | MRK | 15 | 42 | ug97 | figs-metaphor | ἤδη ὀψίας γενομένης | 1 | when evening had already come | Here, **evening** is spoken of as if it were something that is able to **come** from one place to another. Alternate translation: “when it had already become evening” or “when it was evening” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]]) |
1440 | MRK | 15 | 43 | xn8t | writing-participants | ἐλθὼν Ἰωσὴφ ὁ ἀπὸ Ἁριμαθαίας, εὐσχήμων βουλευτής, ὃς καὶ αὐτὸς ἦν προσδεχόμενος τὴν Βασιλείαν τοῦ Θεοῦ; τολμήσας, εἰσῆλθεν πρὸς τὸν Πειλᾶτον | 1 | Joseph who was from Arimathea, a respected member of the council who also was himself waiting for the kingdom of God, having come, he boldly went in to Pilate | The phrase **having come** refers to Joseph coming to Pilate, which is also described after the background information is given, but his coming is referenced before for emphasis and to help introduce him to the story. There may be a different way to do this in your language. Alternate translation: “Joseph of Arimathea was a respected member of the council who also was himself waiting for the kingdom of God. He boldly came to Pilate” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-participants]]) |
1441 | MRK | 15 | 43 | wgz8 | translate-names | Ἰωσὴφ ὁ ἀπὸ Ἁριμαθαίας | 1 | Joseph who was from Arimathea | “Joseph from Arimathea.” **Joseph** is the name of a man, and **Arimathea** is the name of the place his is from. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
1442 | MRK | 15 | 43 | u7ll | writing-background | εὐσχήμων βουλευτής, ὃς καὶ αὐτὸς ἦν προσδεχόμενος τὴν Βασιλείαν τοῦ Θεοῦ | 1 | a respected member of the council who also was himself waiting for the kingdom of God | This is background information about Joseph. (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/writing-background]]) |
1443 | MRK | 15 | 43 | zm1u | τολμήσας, εἰσῆλθεν πρὸς τὸν Πειλᾶτον | 1 | he boldly went in to Pilate | “he boldly went to Pilate” or “he boldly went in to where Pilate was” | |
1444 | MRK | 15 | 43 | zvw4 | figs-explicit | ᾐτήσατο τὸ σῶμα τοῦ Ἰησοῦ | 1 | asked for the body of Jesus | It can be stated clearly that he wanted to get **the body** so that he could bury it. Alternate translation: “asked for permission to get the body of Jesus in order to bury it” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1445 | MRK | 15 | 44 | z3gl | figs-explicit | ὁ δὲ Πειλᾶτος ἐθαύμασεν εἰ ἤδη τέθνηκεν; καὶ προσκαλεσάμενος τὸν κεντυρίωνα | 1 | But Pilate was wondering if he had already died, and having called the centurion | **Pilate** heard people saying that Jesus was dead. This surprised him, so he asked **the centurion** if it was true. This can be made clear. Alternate translation: “Pilate was amazed when he heard that Jesus was already dead, so calling the centurion” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]]) |
1446 | MRK | 15 | 45 | v5ys | ἐδωρήσατο τὸ πτῶμα τῷ Ἰωσήφ | 1 | he gave the body to Joseph | “he permitted Joseph to take Jesus’ body” | |
1447 | MRK | 15 | 46 | g4c9 | σινδόνα | 1 | a linen cloth | Linen is cloth made from the fibers of a flax plant. See how you translated this in [Mark 14:51](../14/51.md). | |
1448 | MRK | 15 | 46 | eb9h | figs-metonymy | καθελὼν αὐτὸν…προσεκύλισεν λίθον | 1 | having taken him down … he rolled a stone | You may need to make explicit that Joseph probably had help from other people when he took Jesus’ body down from the cross, prepared it for the tomb, and closed the tomb. Alternate translation: “after he and others took him down … they rolled a stone” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]]) |
1449 | MRK | 15 | 46 | g9hf | figs-activepassive | μνήματι ὃ ἦν λελατομημένον ἐκ πέτρας | 1 | a tomb that had been cut from a rock | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “a tomb that someone had previously cut out of solid rock” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1450 | MRK | 15 | 46 | bw4k | λίθον ἐπὶ | 1 | a stone against | “a huge flat stone in front of” | |
1451 | MRK | 15 | 47 | m782 | translate-names | Ἰωσῆτος | 1 | of Joses | This **Joses** was not that same person as the younger brother of Jesus. See how you translated the same name in [Mark 6:3](../06/03.md). (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/translate-names]]) |
1452 | MRK | 15 | 47 | v3wu | figs-activepassive | ποῦ τέθειται | 1 | where he was laid | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the place where Joseph and the others buried Jesus’ body” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1453 | MRK | 16 | intro | j5yz | 0 | # Mark 16 General Notes<br><br>## Special concepts in this chapter<br><br>### The tomb<br><br>The tomb in which Jesus was buried ([Mark 15:46](../mrk/15/46.md)) was the kind of tomb in which wealthy Jewish families buried their dead. It was an actual room cut into a rock. It had a flat place on one side where they could place the body after they had put oil and spices on it and wrapped it in cloth. Then they would roll a large rock in front of the tomb so no one could see inside or enter.<br><br>## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter<br><br>### A young man dressed in a white robe<br><br>Matthew, Mark, Luke, and John all wrote about angels in white clothing with the women at Jesus’ tomb. Two of the authors called them men, but that is only because the angels were in human form. Two of the authors wrote about two angels, but the other two authors wrote about only one of them. It is best to translate each of these passages as it appears in the ULT without trying to make the passages all say exactly the same thing. (See: [Matthew 28:1-2](../mat/28/01.md) and [Mark 16:5](../mrk/16/05.md) and [Luke 24:4](../luk/24/04.md) and [John 20:12](../jhn/20/12.md)) | |||
1454 | MRK | 16 | 1 | cw1b | 0 | Connecting Statement: | On the first day of the week, women come early because they expect to use spices to anoint Jesus’ body. They are surprised to see a young man who tells them Jesus is alive, but they are afraid and do not tell anyone. | ||
1455 | MRK | 16 | 1 | p61n | καὶ διαγενομένου τοῦ Σαββάτου | 1 | And the Sabbath having passed | That is, after **the Sabbath**, the seventh day of the week, had ended and the first day of the week had begun. | |
1456 | MRK | 16 | 4 | kld9 | figs-activepassive | ἀποκεκύλισται ὁ λίθος | 1 | the stone had been rolled away | This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “someone had rolled away the stone” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |
1457 | MRK | 16 | 6 | x9m8 | figs-activepassive | ἠγέρθη | 1 | He has been raised! | The angel is emphatically stating that Jesus has risen from the dead. This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “He arose!” or “God raised him from the dead!” or “He raised himself from the dead!” (See: [[rc://en/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]]) |